]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
xfns.c (x_window): Fixed indentation
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000, 01, 02, 2003
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #define XAW_ARROW_SCROLLBARS
135 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
136 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
139 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #ifndef XtNpickTop
141 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
142 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
143 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
144 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
145
146 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
147
148 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
149 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
151 #endif
152
153 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
154 #include "widget.h"
155 #ifndef XtNinitialState
156 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
157 #endif
158 #endif
159
160 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
161
162 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
163 #ifdef USE_XIM
164 int use_xim = 1;
165 #else
166 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
167 #endif
168
169 \f
170
171 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
172
173 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
174
175 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
176 start. */
177
178 static int any_help_event_p;
179
180 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
181 static Lisp_Object last_window;
182
183 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
184
185 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
186
187 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
188 use. */
189
190 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
191
192 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
193 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
194 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
195 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
196
197 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
198
199 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
200 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
201 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
202 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
203
204 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
205
206 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
207
208 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
209
210 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
211 /* The application context for Xt use. */
212 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
213 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
215
216 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
217
218 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
219
220 /* Mouse movement.
221
222 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
223 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
224 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
225 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
226
227 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
228
229 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
230 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
231 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
232 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
233 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
234 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
235 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
236 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
237 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
238 is off. */
239
240 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
241
242 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
243 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
244
245 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
246
247 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
248 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
249 an ordinary motion.
250
251 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
252 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
253 event. */
254
255 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
256
257 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
258 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
259 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
260 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
261 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
262 it's somewhat accurate. */
263
264 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
265
266 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
267 events. */
268
269 #ifdef __STDC__
270 static int volatile input_signal_count;
271 #else
272 static int input_signal_count;
273 #endif
274
275 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
276
277 static int x_noop_count;
278
279 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
280
281 extern char **initial_argv;
282 extern int initial_argc;
283
284 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
285
286 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
287
288 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
289
290 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
291
292 extern int errno;
293
294 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
295
296 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
297
298 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
299
300 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
301 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
302 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
303
304 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
305 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
306
307 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
308 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
309
310 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
311 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
312 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
313 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
314 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
315 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
316 unsigned));
317 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
318 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
319 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
320 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
321 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
322 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
323 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
324 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
325 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
326 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
327 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
328 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
329 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
330 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
331 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
332 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
333 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
334 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
335 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
336 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
337 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
338 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
339 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
340 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
341 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
342 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
343 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
345 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
346 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
347 enum text_cursor_kinds));
348
349 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, GC));
350 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
351 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
352 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
353 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
354 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
355 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
356 enum scroll_bar_part *,
357 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
358 unsigned long *));
359 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
360 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
362 int *, struct input_event *));
363
364
365 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
366
367 static void
368 x_flush (f)
369 struct frame *f;
370 {
371 BLOCK_INPUT;
372 if (f == NULL)
373 {
374 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
375 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
377 }
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
381 }
382
383
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
390
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
392
393 \f
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
397
398 #if 0
399
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
402
403 struct record
404 {
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
407 };
408
409 struct record event_record[100];
410
411 int event_record_index;
412
413 record_event (locus, type)
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
416 {
417 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
418 event_record_index = 0;
419
420 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
421 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
422 event_record_index++;
423 }
424
425 #endif /* 0 */
426
427
428 \f
429 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
430
431 struct x_display_info *
432 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
433 Display *dpy;
434 {
435 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
436
437 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
438 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
439 return dpyinfo;
440
441 return 0;
442 }
443
444
445 \f
446 /***********************************************************************
447 Starting and ending an update
448 ***********************************************************************/
449
450 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
451 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
452 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
453 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
454 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
455
456 static void
457 x_update_begin (f)
458 struct frame *f;
459 {
460 /* Nothing to do. */
461 }
462
463
464 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
465 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
466 position of W. */
467
468 static void
469 x_update_window_begin (w)
470 struct window *w;
471 {
472 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
473 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
474
475 updated_window = w;
476 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
477
478 BLOCK_INPUT;
479
480 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
481 {
482 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
483 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
484
485 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
486 highlighting. */
487 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
488 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
489
490 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
491 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
492 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
493 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
494 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
495 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
496
497 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
498 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
499 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
500 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
501 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
502 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
503 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
504 {
505 int i;
506
507 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
508 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
509 break;
510
511 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
512 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
513 }
514 #endif /* 0 */
515 }
516
517 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
518 }
519
520
521 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
522
523 static void
524 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
525 struct window *w;
526 int x, y0, y1;
527 {
528 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
529
530 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
531 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
532 }
533
534 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
535
536 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
537 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
538
539 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
540 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
541 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
542
543 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
544 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
545 here. */
546
547 static void
548 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
549 struct window *w;
550 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
551 {
552 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
553
554 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
555 {
556 BLOCK_INPUT;
557
558 if (cursor_on_p)
559 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
560 output_cursor.vpos,
561 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
562
563 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
564
565 draw_window_fringes (w);
566
567 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
568 }
569
570 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
571 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
572 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
573 {
574 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
575 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
576 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
577 }
578
579 updated_window = NULL;
580 }
581
582
583 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
584 update_end. */
585
586 static void
587 x_update_end (f)
588 struct frame *f;
589 {
590 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
591 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
592
593 #ifndef XFlush
594 BLOCK_INPUT;
595 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
596 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
597 #endif
598 }
599
600
601 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
602 complete update has been performed. The global variable
603 updated_window is not available here. */
604
605 static void
606 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
607 struct frame *f;
608 {
609 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
610 {
611 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
612
613 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
614 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
615 {
616 BLOCK_INPUT;
617 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
618 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
619 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
620 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
621 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
622 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
623 }
624 }
625 }
626
627
628 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
629 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
630 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
631 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
632 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
633 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
634
635 static void
636 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
637 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
638 {
639 struct window *w = updated_window;
640 struct frame *f;
641 int width, height;
642
643 xassert (w);
644
645 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
646 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
647
648 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
649 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
650 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
651 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
652 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
653 overhead is very small. */
654 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
655 && desired_row->full_width_p
656 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
657 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
658 width != 0)
659 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
660 height > 0))
661 {
662 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
663
664 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
665 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
666 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
667 y -= width;
668
669 BLOCK_INPUT;
670 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
671 0, y, width, height, False);
672 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
673 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
674 y, width, height, False);
675 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
676 }
677 }
678
679 static void
680 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
681 struct window *w;
682 struct glyph_row *row;
683 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
684 {
685 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
686 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
687 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
688 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
689 struct face *face = p->face;
690 int rowY;
691
692 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
693 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
694 if (p->y < rowY)
695 {
696 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
697 visible last row. */
698 int oldY = row->y;
699 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
700 row->visible_height = p->h;
701 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
702 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
703 row->y = oldY;
704 row->visible_height = oldVH;
705 }
706 else
707 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
708
709 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
710 {
711 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
712 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
713 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
714 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
715 if (face->stipple)
716 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
717 else
718 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
719
720 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
721 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
722
723 if (!face->stipple)
724 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
725 }
726
727 if (p->which)
728 {
729 unsigned char *bits;
730 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
731 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
732 XGCValues gcv;
733
734 if (p->wd > 8)
735 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
736 else
737 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
738
739 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
740 by the server. */
741 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
742 (p->cursor_p
743 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
744 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
745 : face->foreground),
746 face->background, depth);
747
748 if (p->overlay_p)
749 {
750 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
751 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
752 bits, p->wd, p->h,
753 1, 0, 1);
754 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
755 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
756 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
757 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
758 }
759
760 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
761 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
762 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
763
764 if (p->overlay_p)
765 {
766 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
767 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
768 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
769 }
770 }
771
772 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
773 }
774
775 \f
776
777 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
778 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
779 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
780 rarely happens). */
781
782 static void
783 XTset_terminal_modes ()
784 {
785 }
786
787 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
788 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
789
790 static void
791 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
792 {
793 }
794
795
796 \f
797 /***********************************************************************
798 Display Iterator
799 ***********************************************************************/
800
801 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
802
803 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
804
805
806 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
807 is not contained in the font. */
808
809 static XCharStruct *
810 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
811 XFontStruct *font;
812 XChar2b *char2b;
813 int font_type; /* unused on X */
814 {
815 /* The result metric information. */
816 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
817
818 xassert (font && char2b);
819
820 if (font->per_char != NULL)
821 {
822 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
823 {
824 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
825 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
826 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
827 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
828 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
829 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
830 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
831 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
832 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
833 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
834 }
835 else
836 {
837 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
838 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
839 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
840 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
841
842 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
843 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
844
845 where:
846
847 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
848 / = integer division
849 \ = integer modulus */
850 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
851 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
852 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
853 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
854 {
855 pcm = (font->per_char
856 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
857 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
858 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
859 }
860 }
861 }
862 else
863 {
864 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
865 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
866 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
867 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
868 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
869 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
870 }
871
872 return ((pcm == NULL
873 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
874 ? NULL : pcm);
875 }
876
877
878 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
879 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
880
881 static int
882 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
883 int c;
884 XChar2b *char2b;
885 struct font_info *font_info;
886 int *two_byte_p;
887 {
888 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
889 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
890
891 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
892 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
893 fixed encoding. */
894 if (font_info->font_encoder)
895 {
896 /* It's a program. */
897 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
898
899 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
900 {
901 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
902 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
903 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
904 }
905 else
906 {
907 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
908 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
909 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
910 }
911
912 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
913
914 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
915 program. */
916 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
917 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
918 else
919 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
920 }
921 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
922 {
923 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
924 encoding numbers. */
925 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
926
927 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
928 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
929 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
930
931 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
932 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
933 }
934
935 if (two_byte_p)
936 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
937
938 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
939 }
940
941
942 \f
943 /***********************************************************************
944 Glyph display
945 ***********************************************************************/
946
947
948
949 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
950 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
951 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
952 int));
953 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
954 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
955 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
956 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
957 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
958 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
959 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
961 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
962 unsigned long *, double, int));
963 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
964 double, int, unsigned long));
965 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
968 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
970 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
971 int, int, int));
972 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
973 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
974 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
975 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
976
977 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
978 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
979 #endif
980
981
982 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
983 face. */
984
985 static void
986 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
987 struct glyph_string *s;
988 {
989 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
990 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
991 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
992 && !s->cmp)
993 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
994 else
995 {
996 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
997 XGCValues xgcv;
998 unsigned long mask;
999
1000 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1001 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1002
1003 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1004 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1005 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1006 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1007 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1008 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1009 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1010
1011 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1012 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1013 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1014 {
1015 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1016 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1017 }
1018
1019 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1020 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1021 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1022 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1023
1024 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1025 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1026 mask, &xgcv);
1027 else
1028 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1029 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1030
1031 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1032 }
1033 }
1034
1035
1036 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1037
1038 static void
1039 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1040 struct glyph_string *s;
1041 {
1042 int face_id;
1043 struct face *face;
1044
1045 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1046 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1047 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1048 if (face == NULL)
1049 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1050
1051 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1052 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1053 else
1054 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1055 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1056 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1057
1058 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1059 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 else
1062 {
1063 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1064 but font FONT. */
1065 XGCValues xgcv;
1066 unsigned long mask;
1067
1068 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1069 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1070 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1071 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1072 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1073 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1074
1075 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1076 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1077 mask, &xgcv);
1078 else
1079 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1080 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1081
1082 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1083 }
1084
1085 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1086 }
1087
1088
1089 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1090 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1091 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1092
1093 static INLINE void
1094 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1095 struct glyph_string *s;
1096 {
1097 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1098 }
1099
1100
1101 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1102 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1103 pattern. */
1104
1105 static INLINE void
1106 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1107 struct glyph_string *s;
1108 {
1109 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1110
1111 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1112 {
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1114 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1115 }
1116 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1117 {
1118 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1119 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1120 }
1121 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1122 {
1123 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1124 s->stippled_p = 0;
1125 }
1126 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1127 {
1128 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1129 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1130 }
1131 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1132 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1133 {
1134 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1136 }
1137 else
1138 {
1139 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1140 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1141 }
1142
1143 /* GC must have been set. */
1144 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1145 }
1146
1147
1148 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1149 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1150
1151 static INLINE void
1152 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1153 struct glyph_string *s;
1154 {
1155 XRectangle r;
1156 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1157 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1158 }
1159
1160
1161 /* RIF:
1162 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1163 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1164
1165 static void
1166 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1167 struct glyph_string *s;
1168 {
1169 if (s->cmp == NULL
1170 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1171 {
1172 XCharStruct cs;
1173 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1174 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1175 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1176 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1177 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1178 }
1179 }
1180
1181
1182 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1183
1184 static INLINE void
1185 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1186 struct glyph_string *s;
1187 int x, y, w, h;
1188 {
1189 XGCValues xgcv;
1190 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1191 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1192 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1193 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1194 }
1195
1196
1197 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1198 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1199 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1200 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1201 contains the first component of a composition. */
1202
1203 static void
1204 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1205 struct glyph_string *s;
1206 int force_p;
1207 {
1208 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1209 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1210 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1211 {
1212 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1213
1214 if (s->stippled_p)
1215 {
1216 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1217 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1218 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1219 s->y + box_line_width,
1220 s->background_width,
1221 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1222 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1223 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1224 }
1225 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1226 || s->font_not_found_p
1227 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1228 || force_p)
1229 {
1230 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1231 s->background_width,
1232 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1233 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1234 }
1235 }
1236 }
1237
1238
1239 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1240
1241 static void
1242 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1243 struct glyph_string *s;
1244 {
1245 int i, x;
1246
1247 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1248 of S to the right of that box line. */
1249 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1250 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1251 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1252 else
1253 x = s->x;
1254
1255 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1256 loaded. */
1257 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1258 {
1259 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1260 {
1261 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1263 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1264 s->height - 1);
1265 x += g->pixel_width;
1266 }
1267 }
1268 else
1269 {
1270 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1271 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1272
1273 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1274 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1275
1276 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1277 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1278 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1279 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1280
1281 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1282 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1283 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1284 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1285 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1286 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1287 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1288 {
1289 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1290 if (s->two_byte_p)
1291 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1292 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1293 else
1294 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1295 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1296 }
1297 else
1298 {
1299 if (s->two_byte_p)
1300 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1301 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1302 else
1303 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1304 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1305 }
1306
1307 if (s->face->overstrike)
1308 {
1309 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1310 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1311 if (s->two_byte_p)
1312 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1313 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1314 else
1315 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1316 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1317 }
1318 }
1319 }
1320
1321 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1322
1323 static void
1324 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1325 struct glyph_string *s;
1326 {
1327 int i, x;
1328
1329 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1330 of S to the right of that box line. */
1331 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1332 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1333 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1334 else
1335 x = s->x;
1336
1337 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1338 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1339 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1340 this composition. */
1341
1342 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1343 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1344 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1345 {
1346 if (s->gidx == 0)
1347 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1348 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1349 }
1350 else
1351 {
1352 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1353 {
1354 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1355 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1356 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1357 s->char2b + i, 1);
1358 if (s->face->overstrike)
1359 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1360 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1361 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1362 s->char2b + i, 1);
1363 }
1364 }
1365 }
1366
1367
1368 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1369
1370 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1371 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1372 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1373 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1374 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1375
1376
1377 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1378 cannot be determined. */
1379
1380 static struct frame *
1381 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1382 Widget widget;
1383 {
1384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1385 Lisp_Object tail;
1386 struct frame *f;
1387
1388 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1389
1390 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1391 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1392 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1393 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1394 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1395 widget = XtParent (widget);
1396
1397 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1398 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1399 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1400 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1401 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1402 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1403 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1404 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1405 return f;
1406
1407 abort ();
1408 }
1409
1410
1411 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1412 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1413 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1414 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1415
1416 int
1417 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1418 Widget widget;
1419 Colormap cmap;
1420 XColor *color;
1421 {
1422 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1423 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1424 }
1425
1426
1427 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1428 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1429 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1430 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1431 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1432 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1433
1434 int
1435 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1436 Widget widget;
1437 Display *display;
1438 Colormap cmap;
1439 unsigned long *pixel;
1440 double factor;
1441 int delta;
1442 {
1443 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1444 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1445 }
1446
1447
1448 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1449 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1450
1451 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1452 {
1453 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1454 sizeof (Screen *)},
1455 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1456 sizeof (Colormap)}
1457 };
1458
1459
1460 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1461 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1462
1463 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1464
1465
1466 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1467
1468 DPY is the display we are working on.
1469
1470 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1471 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1472 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1473 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1474
1475 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1476 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1477
1478 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1479 we allocated the color or not.
1480
1481 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1482
1483 static Boolean
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1485 Display *dpy;
1486 XrmValue *args;
1487 Cardinal *nargs;
1488 XrmValue *from, *to;
1489 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1490 {
1491 Screen *screen;
1492 Colormap cmap;
1493 Pixel pixel;
1494 String color_name;
1495 XColor color;
1496
1497 if (*nargs != 2)
1498 {
1499 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1500 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1501 "XtToolkitError",
1502 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1503 return False;
1504 }
1505
1506 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1507 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1508 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1509
1510 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1511 {
1512 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1513 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1514 }
1515 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1516 {
1517 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1518 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1519 }
1520 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1521 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1522 {
1523 pixel = color.pixel;
1524 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1525 }
1526 else
1527 {
1528 String params[1];
1529 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1530
1531 params[0] = color_name;
1532 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1533 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1534 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1535 params, &nparams);
1536 return False;
1537 }
1538
1539 if (to->addr != NULL)
1540 {
1541 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1542 {
1543 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1544 return False;
1545 }
1546
1547 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1548 }
1549 else
1550 {
1551 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1552 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1553 }
1554
1555 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1556 return True;
1557 }
1558
1559
1560 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1561 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1562 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1563
1564 APP is the application context in which we work.
1565
1566 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1567 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1568 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1569
1570 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1571
1572 static void
1573 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1574 XtAppContext app;
1575 XrmValuePtr to;
1576 XtPointer closure;
1577 XrmValuePtr args;
1578 Cardinal *nargs;
1579 {
1580 if (*nargs != 2)
1581 {
1582 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1583 "XtToolkitError",
1584 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1585 NULL, NULL);
1586 }
1587 else if (closure != NULL)
1588 {
1589 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1590 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1591 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1592 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1593 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1594 }
1595 }
1596
1597
1598 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1599
1600
1601 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1602 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1603 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1604 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1605
1606 static const XColor *
1607 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1608 Display *dpy;
1609 int *ncells;
1610 {
1611 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1612
1613 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1614 {
1615 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1616 int i;
1617
1618 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1619 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1620 dpyinfo->color_cells
1621 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1622 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1623
1624 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1625 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1626
1627 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1628 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1629 }
1630
1631 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1632 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1633 }
1634
1635
1636 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1637 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1638
1639 void
1640 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1641 struct frame *f;
1642 XColor *colors;
1643 int ncolors;
1644 {
1645 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1646
1647 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1648 {
1649 int i;
1650 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1651 {
1652 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1653 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1654 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1655 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1656 }
1657 }
1658 else
1659 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1660 }
1661
1662
1663 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1664 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1665
1666 void
1667 x_query_color (f, color)
1668 struct frame *f;
1669 XColor *color;
1670 {
1671 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1672 }
1673
1674
1675 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1676 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1677 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1678 allocated. */
1679
1680 static int
1681 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1682 Display *dpy;
1683 Colormap cmap;
1684 XColor *color;
1685 {
1686 int rc;
1687
1688 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1689 if (rc == 0)
1690 {
1691 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1692 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1693 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1694 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1695 int nearest, i;
1696 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1697 int ncells;
1698 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1699
1700 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1701 {
1702 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1703 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1704 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1705 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1706
1707 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1708 {
1709 nearest = i;
1710 nearest_delta = delta;
1711 }
1712 }
1713
1714 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1715 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1716 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1717 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1718 }
1719 else
1720 {
1721 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1722 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1723 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1724 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1725 XColor *cached_color;
1726
1727 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1728 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1729 (cached_color->red != color->red
1730 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1731 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1732 {
1733 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1734 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1735 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1736 }
1737 }
1738
1739 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1740 if (rc)
1741 register_color (color->pixel);
1742 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1743
1744 return rc;
1745 }
1746
1747
1748 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1749 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1750 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1751 allocated. */
1752
1753 int
1754 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1755 struct frame *f;
1756 Colormap cmap;
1757 XColor *color;
1758 {
1759 gamma_correct (f, color);
1760 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1761 }
1762
1763
1764 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1765 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1766 get color reference counts right. */
1767
1768 unsigned long
1769 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1770 struct frame *f;
1771 unsigned long pixel;
1772 {
1773 XColor color;
1774
1775 color.pixel = pixel;
1776 BLOCK_INPUT;
1777 x_query_color (f, &color);
1778 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1779 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1780 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1781 register_color (pixel);
1782 #endif
1783 return color.pixel;
1784 }
1785
1786
1787 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1788 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1789 get color reference counts right. */
1790
1791 unsigned long
1792 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1793 Display *dpy;
1794 Colormap cmap;
1795 unsigned long pixel;
1796 {
1797 XColor color;
1798
1799 color.pixel = pixel;
1800 BLOCK_INPUT;
1801 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1802 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1803 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1804 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1805 register_color (pixel);
1806 #endif
1807 return color.pixel;
1808 }
1809
1810
1811 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1812 boosted.
1813
1814 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1815 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1816 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1817 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1818 use an additional additive factor.
1819
1820 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1821 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1822 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1823
1824
1825 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1826 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1827 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1828 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1829 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1830 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1831
1832 static int
1833 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1834 struct frame *f;
1835 Display *display;
1836 Colormap cmap;
1837 unsigned long *pixel;
1838 double factor;
1839 int delta;
1840 {
1841 XColor color, new;
1842 long bright;
1843 int success_p;
1844
1845 /* Get RGB color values. */
1846 color.pixel = *pixel;
1847 x_query_color (f, &color);
1848
1849 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1850 xassert (factor >= 0);
1851 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1852 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1853 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1854
1855 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1856 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1857
1858 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1859 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1860 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1861 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1862 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1863 {
1864 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1865 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1866 /* The additive adjustment. */
1867 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1868
1869 if (factor < 1)
1870 {
1871 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1872 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1873 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1874 }
1875 else
1876 {
1877 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1878 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1879 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1880 }
1881 }
1882
1883 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1884 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1885 if (success_p)
1886 {
1887 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1888 {
1889 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1890 delta to the RGB values. */
1891 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1892
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1896 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1897 }
1898 else
1899 success_p = 1;
1900 *pixel = new.pixel;
1901 }
1902
1903 return success_p;
1904 }
1905
1906
1907 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1908 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1909 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1910 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1911 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1912 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1913
1914 static void
1915 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1916 struct frame *f;
1917 struct relief *relief;
1918 double factor;
1919 int delta;
1920 unsigned long default_pixel;
1921 {
1922 XGCValues xgcv;
1923 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1924 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1925 unsigned long pixel;
1926 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1927 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1928 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1929 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1930
1931 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1932 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1933
1934 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1935 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1936 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1937 if (relief->gc
1938 && relief->allocated_p)
1939 {
1940 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1941 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1942 }
1943
1944 /* Allocate new color. */
1945 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1946 pixel = background;
1947 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1948 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1949 {
1950 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1951 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1952 }
1953
1954 if (relief->gc == 0)
1955 {
1956 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1957 mask |= GCStipple;
1958 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1959 }
1960 else
1961 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1962 }
1963
1964
1965 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1966
1967 static void
1968 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1969 struct glyph_string *s;
1970 {
1971 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1972 unsigned long color;
1973
1974 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1975 color = s->face->box_color;
1976 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1977 && s->img->pixmap
1978 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1979 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1980 else
1981 {
1982 XGCValues xgcv;
1983
1984 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1985 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1986 color = xgcv.background;
1987 }
1988
1989 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1990 || color != di->relief_background)
1991 {
1992 di->relief_background = color;
1993 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1994 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1995 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1996 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1997 }
1998 }
1999
2000
2001 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2002 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2003 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2004 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2005 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2006 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2007 when drawing. */
2008
2009 static void
2010 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2011 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2012 struct frame *f;
2013 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2014 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2015 {
2016 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2017 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2018 int i;
2019 GC gc;
2020
2021 if (raised_p)
2022 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2023 else
2024 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2025 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2026
2027 /* Top. */
2028 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2029 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2030 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2031 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2032
2033 /* Left. */
2034 if (left_p)
2035 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2036 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2037 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2038
2039 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2040 if (raised_p)
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 else
2043 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2044 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2045
2046 /* Bottom. */
2047 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2050 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2051
2052 /* Right. */
2053 if (right_p)
2054 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2057
2058 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2059 }
2060
2061
2062 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2063 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2064 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2065 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2066 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2067 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2068
2069 static void
2070 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2071 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2072 struct glyph_string *s;
2073 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2074 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2075 {
2076 XGCValues xgcv;
2077
2078 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2079 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2080 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2081
2082 /* Top. */
2083 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2084 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2085
2086 /* Left. */
2087 if (left_p)
2088 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2089 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2090
2091 /* Bottom. */
2092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2093 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2094
2095 /* Right. */
2096 if (right_p)
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2099
2100 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2101 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2102 }
2103
2104
2105 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2106
2107 static void
2108 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2109 struct glyph_string *s;
2110 {
2111 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2112 int left_p, right_p;
2113 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2114 XRectangle clip_rect;
2115
2116 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2117 if (s->row->full_width_p
2118 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2119 {
2120 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2121 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2122 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2123 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2124 }
2125
2126 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2127 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2128 ? s->first_glyph
2129 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2130
2131 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2132 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2133 left_x = s->x;
2134 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2135 ? last_x - 1
2136 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2137 top_y = s->y;
2138 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2139
2140 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2141 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2142 && (s->prev == NULL
2143 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2144 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2145 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2146 && (s->next == NULL
2147 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2148
2149 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2150
2151 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2152 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2153 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2154 else
2155 {
2156 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2157 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2158 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2159 }
2160 }
2161
2162
2163 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2164
2165 static void
2166 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2167 struct glyph_string *s;
2168 {
2169 int x;
2170 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2171
2172 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2173 right of that line. */
2174 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2175 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2176 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2177 else
2178 x = s->x;
2179
2180 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2181 by that margin. */
2182 x += s->img->hmargin;
2183 y += s->img->vmargin;
2184
2185 if (s->img->pixmap)
2186 {
2187 if (s->img->mask)
2188 {
2189 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2190 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2191 trust on the shape extension to be available
2192 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2193 manually. */
2194 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2195 | GCFunction);
2196 XGCValues xgcv;
2197 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2198
2199 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2200 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2201 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2202 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2203 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2204
2205 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2206 image_rect.x = x;
2207 image_rect.y = y;
2208 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2209 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2210 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2211 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2212 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2213 }
2214 else
2215 {
2216 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2217
2218 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2219 image_rect.x = x;
2220 image_rect.y = y;
2221 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2222 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2223 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2224 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2225 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2226
2227 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2228 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2229 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2230 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2231 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2232 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2233 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2234 {
2235 int r = s->img->relief;
2236 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2237 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2238 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2239 }
2240 }
2241 }
2242 else
2243 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2244 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2245 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2246 }
2247
2248
2249 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2250
2251 static void
2252 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2253 struct glyph_string *s;
2254 {
2255 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2256 XRectangle r;
2257 int x;
2258 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2259
2260 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2261 right of that line. */
2262 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2263 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2264 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2265 else
2266 x = s->x;
2267
2268 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2269 by that margin. */
2270 x += s->img->hmargin;
2271 y += s->img->vmargin;
2272
2273 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2274 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2275 {
2276 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2277 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2278 }
2279 else
2280 {
2281 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2282 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2283 }
2284
2285 x0 = x - thick;
2286 y0 = y - thick;
2287 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
2288 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
2289
2290 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2291 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2292 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
2293 }
2294
2295
2296 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2297
2298 static void
2299 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2300 struct glyph_string *s;
2301 Pixmap pixmap;
2302 {
2303 int x;
2304 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2305
2306 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2307 right of that line. */
2308 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2309 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2310 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2311 else
2312 x = 0;
2313
2314 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2315 by that margin. */
2316 x += s->img->hmargin;
2317 y += s->img->vmargin;
2318
2319 if (s->img->pixmap)
2320 {
2321 if (s->img->mask)
2322 {
2323 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2324 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2325 trust on the shape extension to be available
2326 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2327 manually. */
2328 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2329 | GCFunction);
2330 XGCValues xgcv;
2331
2332 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2333 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2334 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2335 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2336 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2337
2338 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2339 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2340 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2341 }
2342 else
2343 {
2344 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2345 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2346
2347 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2348 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2349 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2350 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2351 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2352 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2353 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2354 {
2355 int r = s->img->relief;
2356 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2357 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2358 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2359 }
2360 }
2361 }
2362 else
2363 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2364 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2365 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2366 }
2367
2368
2369 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2370 give the rectangle to draw. */
2371
2372 static void
2373 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2374 struct glyph_string *s;
2375 int x, y, w, h;
2376 {
2377 if (s->stippled_p)
2378 {
2379 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2380 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2381 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2382 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2383 }
2384 else
2385 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2386 }
2387
2388
2389 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2390
2391 s->y
2392 s->x +-------------------------
2393 | s->face->box
2394 |
2395 | +-------------------------
2396 | | s->img->margin
2397 | |
2398 | | +-------------------
2399 | | | the image
2400
2401 */
2402
2403 static void
2404 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2405 struct glyph_string *s;
2406 {
2407 int x, y;
2408 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2409 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2410 int height;
2411 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2412
2413 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
2414
2415
2416 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2417 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2418 flickering. */
2419 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2420 if (height > s->img->height
2421 || s->img->hmargin
2422 || s->img->vmargin
2423 || s->img->mask
2424 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2425 || s->width != s->background_width)
2426 {
2427 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2428 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
2429 else
2430 x = s->x;
2431
2432 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
2433
2434 if (s->img->mask)
2435 {
2436 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2437 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2438 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2439 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2440 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2441
2442 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2443 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2444 s->background_width,
2445 s->height, depth);
2446
2447 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2448 pixmap. */
2449 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2450
2451 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2452 if (s->stippled_p)
2453 {
2454 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2455 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2456 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2457 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2458 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2459 }
2460 else
2461 {
2462 XGCValues xgcv;
2463 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2464 &xgcv);
2465 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2466 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2467 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2468 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2469 }
2470 }
2471 else
2472 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2473
2474 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2475 }
2476
2477 /* Draw the foreground. */
2478 if (pixmap != None)
2479 {
2480 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2481 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2482 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2483 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2484 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2485 }
2486 else
2487 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2488
2489 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2490 if (s->img->relief
2491 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2492 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2493 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2494 }
2495
2496
2497 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2498
2499 static void
2500 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2501 struct glyph_string *s;
2502 {
2503 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2504 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2505
2506 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2507 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2508 {
2509 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2510 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2511 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2512
2513 /* Draw cursor. */
2514 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2515
2516 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2517 if (width < s->background_width)
2518 {
2519 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2520 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2521 XRectangle r;
2522 GC gc;
2523
2524 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2525 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2526 {
2527 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2528 gc = s->gc;
2529 }
2530 else
2531 gc = s->face->gc;
2532
2533 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2534 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2535
2536 if (s->face->stipple)
2537 {
2538 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2539 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2540 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2541 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2542 }
2543 else
2544 {
2545 XGCValues xgcv;
2546 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2547 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2548 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2549 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2550 }
2551 }
2552 }
2553 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2554 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2555 s->height);
2556
2557 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2558 }
2559
2560
2561 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2562
2563 static void
2564 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2565 struct glyph_string *s;
2566 {
2567 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2568
2569 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2570 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2571 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2572 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2573 {
2574 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2575 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2576 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2577 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2578 }
2579
2580 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2581 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2582
2583 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2584 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2585 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2586 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2587 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2588 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2589
2590 {
2591 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2592 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2593 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2594 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2595 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2596 }
2597 else
2598 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2599
2600 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2601 {
2602 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2603 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2604 break;
2605
2606 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2607 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2608 break;
2609
2610 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2611 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2612 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2613 else
2614 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2615 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2616 break;
2617
2618 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2619 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2620 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2621 else
2622 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2623 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2624 break;
2625
2626 default:
2627 abort ();
2628 }
2629
2630 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2631 {
2632 /* Draw underline. */
2633 if (s->face->underline_p)
2634 {
2635 unsigned long tem, h;
2636 int y;
2637
2638 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2639 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2640 h = 1;
2641
2642 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2643 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2644 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2645 specs, and its default is
2646
2647 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2648 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2649
2650 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2651 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2652 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2653 else if (s->face->font)
2654 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2655 else
2656 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2657
2658 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2659 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2660 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2661 else
2662 {
2663 XGCValues xgcv;
2664 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2665 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2666 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2667 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2668 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2669 }
2670 }
2671
2672 /* Draw overline. */
2673 if (s->face->overline_p)
2674 {
2675 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2676
2677 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2678 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2679 s->width, h);
2680 else
2681 {
2682 XGCValues xgcv;
2683 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2684 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2685 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2686 s->width, h);
2687 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2688 }
2689 }
2690
2691 /* Draw strike-through. */
2692 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2693 {
2694 unsigned long h = 1;
2695 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2696
2697 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2698 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2699 s->width, h);
2700 else
2701 {
2702 XGCValues xgcv;
2703 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2705 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2706 s->width, h);
2707 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2708 }
2709 }
2710
2711 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2712 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2713 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2714 }
2715
2716 /* Reset clipping. */
2717 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2718 }
2719
2720 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2721
2722 void
2723 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2724 struct frame *f;
2725 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2726 {
2727 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2728 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2729 x, y, width, height,
2730 x + shift_by, y);
2731 }
2732
2733 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2734 for X frames. */
2735
2736 static void
2737 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2738 register int n;
2739 {
2740 abort ();
2741 }
2742
2743
2744 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2745 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2746
2747 void
2748 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2749 Display *dpy;
2750 Window window;
2751 int x, y;
2752 int width, height;
2753 int exposures;
2754 {
2755 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2756 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2757 }
2758
2759
2760 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2761 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2762
2763 static void
2764 x_clear_frame ()
2765 {
2766 struct frame *f;
2767
2768 if (updating_frame)
2769 f = updating_frame;
2770 else
2771 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2772
2773 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2774 longer visible. */
2775 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2776 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2777 output_cursor.x = -1;
2778
2779 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2780 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2781 BLOCK_INPUT;
2782 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2783
2784 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2785 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2786 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2787
2788 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2789
2790 #ifdef USE_GTK
2791 xg_frame_cleared (f);
2792 #endif
2793
2794 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2795 }
2796
2797
2798 \f
2799 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2800
2801 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2802 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2803
2804 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2805
2806
2807 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2808 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2809
2810 static int
2811 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2812 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2813 {
2814 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2815 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2816 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2817 {
2818 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2819 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2820 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2821 }
2822
2823 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2824 {
2825 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2826 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2827 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2828 }
2829
2830 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2831 positive. */
2832 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2833 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2834
2835 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2836 negative. */
2837 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2838 }
2839
2840 void
2841 XTflash (f)
2842 struct frame *f;
2843 {
2844 BLOCK_INPUT;
2845
2846 {
2847 GC gc;
2848
2849 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2850 pixels into background pixels. */
2851 {
2852 XGCValues values;
2853
2854 values.function = GXxor;
2855 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2856 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2857
2858 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2859 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2860 }
2861
2862 {
2863 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2864 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2865 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2866 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2867 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2868 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2869 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2870
2871 int width;
2872
2873 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2874 edge it is next to. */
2875 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2876 {
2877 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2878 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2879 break;
2880
2881 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2882 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2883 break;
2884
2885 default:
2886 break;
2887 }
2888
2889 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2890
2891 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2892 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2893 {
2894 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2895 flash_left,
2896 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2897 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2898 width, flash_height);
2899 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2900 flash_left,
2901 (height - flash_height
2902 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2903 width, flash_height);
2904 }
2905 else
2906 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2907 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2908 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2909 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2910
2911 x_flush (f);
2912
2913 {
2914 struct timeval wakeup;
2915
2916 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2917
2918 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2919 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2920 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2921 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2922
2923 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2924 available. */
2925 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2926 {
2927 struct timeval current;
2928 struct timeval timeout;
2929
2930 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2931
2932 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2933 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2934 break;
2935
2936 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2937 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2938 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2939
2940 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2941 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2942 }
2943 }
2944
2945 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2946 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2947 {
2948 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2949 flash_left,
2950 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2951 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2952 width, flash_height);
2953 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2954 flash_left,
2955 (height - flash_height
2956 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2957 width, flash_height);
2958 }
2959 else
2960 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2961 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2962 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2963 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2964
2965 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2966 x_flush (f);
2967 }
2968 }
2969
2970 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2971 }
2972
2973 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
2974
2975
2976 /* Make audible bell. */
2977
2978 void
2979 XTring_bell ()
2980 {
2981 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2982
2983 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
2984 {
2985 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2986 if (visible_bell)
2987 XTflash (f);
2988 else
2989 #endif
2990 {
2991 BLOCK_INPUT;
2992 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
2993 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2994 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2995 }
2996 }
2997 }
2998
2999 \f
3000 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3001 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3002 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3003 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3004
3005 static void
3006 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3007 register int n;
3008 {
3009 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3010 }
3011
3012
3013 \f
3014 /***********************************************************************
3015 Line Dance
3016 ***********************************************************************/
3017
3018 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3019 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3020
3021 static void
3022 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3023 int vpos, n;
3024 {
3025 abort ();
3026 }
3027
3028
3029 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3030
3031 static void
3032 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3033 struct window *w;
3034 struct run *run;
3035 {
3036 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3037 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3038
3039 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3040 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3041 fringe of W. */
3042 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3043
3044 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3045 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3046 bottom_y = y + height;
3047
3048 if (to_y < from_y)
3049 {
3050 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3051 line at the bottom. */
3052 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3053 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3054 else
3055 height = run->height;
3056 }
3057 else
3058 {
3059 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3060 at the bottom. */
3061 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3062 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3063 else
3064 height = run->height;
3065 }
3066
3067 BLOCK_INPUT;
3068
3069 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3070 updated_window = w;
3071 x_clear_cursor (w);
3072
3073 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3074 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3075 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3076 x, from_y,
3077 width, height,
3078 x, to_y);
3079
3080 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3081 }
3082
3083
3084 \f
3085 /***********************************************************************
3086 Exposure Events
3087 ***********************************************************************/
3088
3089 \f
3090 static void
3091 frame_highlight (f)
3092 struct frame *f;
3093 {
3094 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3095 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3096 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3097 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3098 BLOCK_INPUT;
3099 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3100 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3101 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3102 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3103 }
3104
3105 static void
3106 frame_unhighlight (f)
3107 struct frame *f;
3108 {
3109 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3110 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3111 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3112 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3113 BLOCK_INPUT;
3114 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3115 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3116 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3117 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3118 }
3119
3120 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3121 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3122 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3123 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3124 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3125
3126 static void
3127 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3128 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3129 struct frame *frame;
3130 {
3131 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3132
3133 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3134 {
3135 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3136 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3137 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3138
3139 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3140 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3141
3142 #if 0
3143 selected_frame = frame;
3144 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3145 selected_frame);
3146 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3147 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3148 #endif /* ! 0 */
3149
3150 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3151 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3152 else
3153 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3154 }
3155
3156 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3157 }
3158
3159 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3160 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3161 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3162
3163 static void
3164 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3165 int type;
3166 int state;
3167 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3168 struct frame *frame;
3169 struct input_event *bufp;
3170 {
3171 if (type == FocusIn)
3172 {
3173 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3174 {
3175 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3176 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3177
3178 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3179 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3180 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3181 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3182 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3183 {
3184 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3185 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3186 }
3187 }
3188
3189 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3190
3191 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3192 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3193 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3194 #endif
3195 }
3196 else if (type == FocusOut)
3197 {
3198 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3199
3200 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3201 {
3202 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3203 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3204 }
3205
3206 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3207 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3208 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3209 #endif
3210 }
3211 }
3212
3213 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3214 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3215
3216 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3217
3218 static void
3219 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3220 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3221 XEvent *event;
3222 struct input_event *bufp;
3223 {
3224 struct frame *frame;
3225 int nr_events = 0;
3226
3227 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3228 if (! frame)
3229 return;
3230
3231 switch (event->type)
3232 {
3233 case EnterNotify:
3234 case LeaveNotify:
3235 {
3236 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3237 int focus_state
3238 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3239
3240 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3241 && event->xcrossing.focus
3242 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3243 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3244 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3245 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3246 }
3247 break;
3248
3249 case FocusIn:
3250 case FocusOut:
3251 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3252 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3253 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3254 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3255 break;
3256 }
3257 }
3258
3259
3260 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3261
3262 void
3263 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3264 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3265 {
3266 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3267 }
3268
3269 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3270 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3271 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3272
3273 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3274 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3275 the appropriate X display info. */
3276
3277 static void
3278 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3279 struct frame *frame;
3280 {
3281 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3282 }
3283
3284 static void
3285 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3286 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3287 {
3288 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3289
3290 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3291 {
3292 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3293 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3294 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3295 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3296 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3297 {
3298 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3299 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3300 }
3301 }
3302 else
3303 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3304
3305 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3306 {
3307 if (old_highlight)
3308 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3309 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3310 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3311 }
3312 }
3313
3314
3315 \f
3316 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3317
3318 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3319 static void
3320 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3321 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3322 {
3323 int min_code, max_code;
3324 KeySym *syms;
3325 int syms_per_code;
3326 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3327
3328 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3329 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3330 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3331 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3332 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3333
3334 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3335 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3336 #else
3337 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3338 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3339 #endif
3340
3341 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3342 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3343 &syms_per_code);
3344 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3345
3346 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3347 Alt keysyms are on. */
3348 {
3349 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3350
3351 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3352 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3353 {
3354 KeyCode code
3355 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3356
3357 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3358 if (code == 0)
3359 continue;
3360
3361 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3362 {
3363 int code_col;
3364
3365 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3366 {
3367 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3368
3369 switch (sym)
3370 {
3371 case XK_Meta_L:
3372 case XK_Meta_R:
3373 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3374 break;
3375
3376 case XK_Alt_L:
3377 case XK_Alt_R:
3378 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3379 break;
3380
3381 case XK_Hyper_L:
3382 case XK_Hyper_R:
3383 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3384 break;
3385
3386 case XK_Super_L:
3387 case XK_Super_R:
3388 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3389 break;
3390
3391 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3392 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3393 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
3394 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3395 break;
3396 }
3397 }
3398 }
3399 }
3400 }
3401
3402 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3403 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3404 {
3405 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3406 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3407 }
3408
3409 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3410 make them just meta, not alt. */
3411 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3412 {
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3414 }
3415
3416 XFree ((char *) syms);
3417 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3418 }
3419
3420 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3421 Emacs uses. */
3422
3423 static unsigned int
3424 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3425 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3426 unsigned int state;
3427 {
3428 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3429 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3430 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3431 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3432 Lisp_Object tem;
3433
3434 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3435 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3436 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3437 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3438 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3439 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3440 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3441 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3442
3443
3444 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3445 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3446 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3447 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3448 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3449 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3450 }
3451
3452 static unsigned int
3453 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3455 unsigned int state;
3456 {
3457 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3458 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3459 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3460 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3461
3462 Lisp_Object tem;
3463
3464 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3465 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3466 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3467 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3468 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3469 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3470 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3471 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3472
3473
3474 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3475 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3476 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3477 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3478 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3479 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3480 }
3481
3482 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3483
3484 char *
3485 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3486 KeySym keysym;
3487 {
3488 char *value;
3489
3490 BLOCK_INPUT;
3491 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3492 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3493
3494 return value;
3495 }
3496
3497
3498 \f
3499 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3500
3501 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3502
3503 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3504 the mouse. */
3505
3506 static Lisp_Object
3507 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3508 struct input_event *result;
3509 XButtonEvent *event;
3510 struct frame *f;
3511 {
3512 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3513 otherwise. */
3514 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3515 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3516 result->timestamp = event->time;
3517 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3518 event->state)
3519 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3520 ? up_modifier
3521 : down_modifier));
3522
3523 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3524 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3525 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3526 result->arg = Qnil;
3527 return Qnil;
3528 }
3529
3530 \f
3531 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3532 The input handler calls this.
3533
3534 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3535 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3536 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3537 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3538
3539 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3540 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3541
3542 static void
3543 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3544 FRAME_PTR frame;
3545 XMotionEvent *event;
3546 {
3547 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3548 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3549 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3550
3551 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3552 {
3553 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3554 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3555 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3556 }
3557
3558 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3559 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3560 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3561 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3562 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3563 {
3564 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3565 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3566 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3567 }
3568 }
3569
3570 \f
3571 /************************************************************************
3572 Mouse Face
3573 ************************************************************************/
3574
3575 static void
3576 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3577 {
3578 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3579 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3580 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3581 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3582 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3583 }
3584
3585
3586 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3587
3588
3589 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3590 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3591 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3592 values. */
3593
3594 static int
3595 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3596 struct frame *f;
3597 int x, y;
3598 XRectangle *rect;
3599 {
3600 Lisp_Object window;
3601 struct window *w;
3602 struct glyph_row *r, *end_row;
3603
3604 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3605 if (NILP (window))
3606 return 0;
3607
3608 w = XWINDOW (window);
3609 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3610 end_row = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3611
3612 for (; r < end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3613 {
3614 if (r->y >= y)
3615 {
3616 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3617 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3618 int gx = r->x;
3619 while (g < end && gx < x)
3620 gx += g->pixel_width, ++g;
3621 if (g < end)
3622 {
3623 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3624 rect->height = r->height;
3625 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3626 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3627 return 1;
3628 }
3629 break;
3630 }
3631 }
3632
3633 return 0;
3634 }
3635
3636
3637 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3638 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3639
3640 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3641 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3642 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3643 position on the scroll bar.
3644
3645 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3646 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3647 the mouse is over.
3648
3649 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3650 was at this position.
3651
3652 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3653
3654 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3655 movement. */
3656
3657 static void
3658 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3659 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3660 int insist;
3661 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3662 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3663 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3664 unsigned long *time;
3665 {
3666 FRAME_PTR f1;
3667
3668 BLOCK_INPUT;
3669
3670 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3671 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3672 else
3673 {
3674 Window root;
3675 int root_x, root_y;
3676
3677 Window dummy_window;
3678 int dummy;
3679
3680 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3681
3682 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3683 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3684 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3685 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3686
3687 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3688
3689 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3690 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3691 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3692
3693 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3694 &root,
3695
3696 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3697 a different screen. */
3698 &dummy_window,
3699
3700 /* The position on that root window. */
3701 &root_x, &root_y,
3702
3703 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3704 &dummy, &dummy,
3705
3706 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3707 we don't care. */
3708 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3709
3710 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3711 containing the pointer. */
3712 {
3713 Window win, child;
3714 int win_x, win_y;
3715 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3716 int count;
3717
3718 win = root;
3719
3720 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3721 structure is changing at the same time this function
3722 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3723
3724 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3725
3726 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3727 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3728 {
3729 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3730 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3731 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3732
3733 /* From-window, to-window. */
3734 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3735
3736 /* From-position, to-position. */
3737 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3738
3739 /* Child of win. */
3740 &child);
3741 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3742 }
3743 else
3744 {
3745 while (1)
3746 {
3747 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3748
3749 /* From-window, to-window. */
3750 root, win,
3751
3752 /* From-position, to-position. */
3753 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3754
3755 /* Child of win. */
3756 &child);
3757
3758 if (child == None || child == win)
3759 break;
3760
3761 win = child;
3762 parent_x = win_x;
3763 parent_y = win_y;
3764 }
3765
3766 /* Now we know that:
3767 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3768 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3769 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3770 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3771 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3772 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3773 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3774 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3775 never use them in that case.) */
3776
3777 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3778 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3779
3780 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3781 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3782 on the frame. */
3783 if (f1 != NULL
3784 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3785 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3786 f1 = NULL;
3787 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3788 }
3789
3790 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3791 f1 = 0;
3792
3793 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3794
3795 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3796 if (! f1)
3797 {
3798 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3799
3800 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3801
3802 if (bar)
3803 {
3804 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3805 win_x = parent_x;
3806 win_y = parent_y;
3807 }
3808 }
3809
3810 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3811 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3812
3813 if (f1)
3814 {
3815 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3816 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3817 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3818 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3819 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3820 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3821 the frame are divided into. */
3822
3823 int width, height, gx, gy;
3824 XRectangle rect;
3825
3826 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3827 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3828 else
3829 {
3830 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3831 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3832 gx = win_x;
3833 gy = win_y;
3834
3835 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3836 round down even for negative values. */
3837 if (gx < 0)
3838 gx -= width - 1;
3839 if (gy < 0)
3840 gy -= height - 1;
3841 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3842 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3843
3844 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3845 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3846 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3847 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3848 }
3849
3850 *bar_window = Qnil;
3851 *part = 0;
3852 *fp = f1;
3853 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3854 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3855 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3856 }
3857 }
3858 }
3859
3860 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3861 }
3862
3863
3864 \f
3865 /***********************************************************************
3866 Scroll bars
3867 ***********************************************************************/
3868
3869 /* Scroll bar support. */
3870
3871 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3872 manages it.
3873 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3874 bits. */
3875
3876 static struct scroll_bar *
3877 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3878 Display *display;
3879 Window window_id;
3880 {
3881 Lisp_Object tail;
3882
3883 #ifdef USE_GTK
3884 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3885 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3886
3887 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3888 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3889 tail = XCDR (tail))
3890 {
3891 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3892
3893 frame = XCAR (tail);
3894 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3895 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3896 abort ();
3897
3898 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3899 right window ID. */
3900 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3901 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3902 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3903 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3904 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3905 condemned = Qnil,
3906 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3907 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3908 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3909 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3910 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3911 }
3912
3913 return 0;
3914 }
3915
3916
3917 #if defined USE_LUCID
3918
3919 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3920 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3921
3922 static Widget
3923 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3924 Window window;
3925 {
3926 Lisp_Object tail;
3927
3928 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3929 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3930 tail = XCDR (tail))
3931 {
3932 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3933 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3934
3935 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3936 return menu_bar;
3937 }
3938
3939 return NULL;
3940 }
3941
3942 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3943
3944 \f
3945 /************************************************************************
3946 Toolkit scroll bars
3947 ************************************************************************/
3948
3949 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3950
3951 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3952 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3953 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3954 struct scroll_bar *));
3955 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3956 int, int, int));
3957
3958
3959 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3960 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3961
3962 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3963
3964 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3965
3966 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3967
3968 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3969 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3970
3971 #ifndef USE_GTK
3972 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3973
3974 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3975
3976 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3977
3978 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3979 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3980 to avoid jerkyness. */
3981
3982 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3983
3984 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
3985
3986 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3987 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3988 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3989 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3990
3991 static void
3992 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3993 num_params)
3994 Widget widget;
3995 XtPointer client_data;
3996 String action_name;
3997 XEvent *event;
3998 String *params;
3999 Cardinal *num_params;
4000 {
4001 int scroll_bar_p;
4002 char *end_action;
4003
4004 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4005 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4006 end_action = "Release";
4007 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4008 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4009 end_action = "EndScroll";
4010 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4011
4012 if (scroll_bar_p
4013 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4014 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4015 {
4016 struct window *w;
4017
4018 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4019 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4020 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4021
4022 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4023 {
4024 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4025 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4026 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4027 }
4028 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4029 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4030
4031 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4032 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4033 }
4034 }
4035 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4036
4037 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4038 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4039
4040 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4041 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4042
4043
4044 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4045 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4046 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4047 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4048
4049 static void
4050 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4051 Lisp_Object window;
4052 int part, portion, whole;
4053 {
4054 XEvent event;
4055 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4056 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4057 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4058 int i;
4059
4060 BLOCK_INPUT;
4061
4062 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4063 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4064 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4065 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4066 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4067 ev->format = 32;
4068
4069 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4070 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4071 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4072 into that array in the event. */
4073 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4074 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4075 break;
4076
4077 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4078 {
4079 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4080 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4081 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4082
4083 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4084 nbytes);
4085 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4086 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4087 }
4088
4089 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4090 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4091 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4092 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4093 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4094 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4095
4096 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4097 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4098
4099 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4100 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4101 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4102 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4103 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4104 }
4105
4106
4107 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4108 in *IEVENT. */
4109
4110 static void
4111 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4112 XEvent *event;
4113 struct input_event *ievent;
4114 {
4115 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4116 Lisp_Object window;
4117 struct frame *f;
4118 struct window *w;
4119
4120 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4121 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4122
4123 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4124 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4125
4126 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4127 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4128 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4129 #ifdef USE_GTK
4130 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4131 #else
4132 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4133 #endif
4134 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4135 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4136 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4137 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4138 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4139 }
4140
4141
4142 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4143
4144 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4145
4146 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4147
4148
4149 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4150 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4151 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4152
4153 static void
4154 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4155 Widget widget;
4156 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4157 {
4158 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4159 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4160 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4161
4162 switch (cs->reason)
4163 {
4164 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4165 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4166 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4167 break;
4168
4169 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4170 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4171 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4172 break;
4173
4174 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4175 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4176 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4177 break;
4178
4179 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4180 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4181 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4182 break;
4183
4184 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4185 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4186 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4187 break;
4188
4189 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4190 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4191 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4192 break;
4193
4194 case XmCR_DRAG:
4195 {
4196 int slider_size;
4197
4198 /* Get the slider size. */
4199 BLOCK_INPUT;
4200 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4201 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4202
4203 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4204 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4205 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4206 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4207 }
4208 break;
4209
4210 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4211 break;
4212 };
4213
4214 if (part >= 0)
4215 {
4216 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4217 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4218 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4219 }
4220 }
4221
4222
4223 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4224 #ifdef USE_GTK
4225 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4226 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4227
4228 static void
4229 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4230 GtkRange *widget;
4231 gpointer data;
4232 {
4233 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4234 gdouble previous;
4235 gdouble position;
4236 gdouble *p;
4237 int diff;
4238
4239 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4240 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4241
4242 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4243
4244 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4245
4246 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4247 if (! p)
4248 {
4249 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4250 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4251 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4252 }
4253
4254 previous = *p;
4255 *p = position;
4256
4257 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4258
4259 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4260 {
4261 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4262 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4263 }
4264 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4265 {
4266 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4267 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4268 }
4269 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4270 {
4271 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4272 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4273 }
4274 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4275 {
4276 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4277 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4278 }
4279 else
4280 {
4281 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4282 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4283 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4284 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4285 }
4286
4287 if (part >= 0)
4288 {
4289 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4290 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4291 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4292 }
4293 }
4294
4295 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4296
4297 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4298 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4299 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4300 the thumb is. */
4301
4302 static void
4303 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4304 Widget widget;
4305 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4306 {
4307 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4308 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4309 float shown;
4310 int whole, portion, height;
4311 int part;
4312
4313 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4314 BLOCK_INPUT;
4315 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4316 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4317
4318 whole = 10000000;
4319 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4320
4321 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4322 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4323 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4324 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4325 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4326 bottom). */
4327 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4328 else
4329 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4330
4331 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4332 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4333 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4334 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4335 }
4336
4337
4338 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4339 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4340 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4341 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4342 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4343 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4344 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4345
4346 static void
4347 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4348 Widget widget;
4349 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4350 {
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4353 int position = (long) call_data;
4354 Dimension height;
4355 int part;
4356
4357 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4358 BLOCK_INPUT;
4359 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4361
4362 if (abs (position) >= height)
4363 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4364
4365 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4366 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4367 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4368 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4369 else
4370 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4371
4372 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4374 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4375 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4376 }
4377
4378 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4379 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4380
4381 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4382
4383 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4384 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4385
4386 #ifdef USE_GTK
4387 static void
4388 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4389 struct frame *f;
4390 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4391 {
4392 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4393
4394 BLOCK_INPUT;
4395 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4396 scroll_bar_name);
4397 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4398 }
4399
4400 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4401
4402 static void
4403 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4404 struct frame *f;
4405 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4406 {
4407 Window xwindow;
4408 Widget widget;
4409 Arg av[20];
4410 int ac = 0;
4411 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4412 unsigned long pixel;
4413
4414 BLOCK_INPUT;
4415
4416 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4417 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4418 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4419 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4420 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4421 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4422 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4423 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4424 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4425
4426 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4427 if (pixel != -1)
4428 {
4429 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4430 ++ac;
4431 }
4432
4433 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4434 if (pixel != -1)
4435 {
4436 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4437 ++ac;
4438 }
4439
4440 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4441 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4442
4443 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4444 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4445 (XtPointer) bar);
4446 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4447 (XtPointer) bar);
4448 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4449 (XtPointer) bar);
4450 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4451 (XtPointer) bar);
4452 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4453 (XtPointer) bar);
4454 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4455 (XtPointer) bar);
4456 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4457 (XtPointer) bar);
4458
4459 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4460 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4461
4462 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4463 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4464 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4465 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4466
4467 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4468
4469 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4470 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4471 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4472 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4473 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4474 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4475 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4476 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4477
4478 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4479 if (pixel != -1)
4480 {
4481 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4482 ++ac;
4483 }
4484
4485 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4486 if (pixel != -1)
4487 {
4488 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4489 ++ac;
4490 }
4491
4492 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4493
4494 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4495 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4496 {
4497 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4498 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4499 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4500 pixel = -1;
4501 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4502 }
4503 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4504 {
4505 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4506 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4507 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4508 pixel = -1;
4509 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4510 }
4511
4512 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4513 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4514 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4515 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4516 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4517 {
4518 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4519 ++ac;
4520 }
4521 else
4522 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4523 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4524 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4525 {
4526 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4527 the shadows. */
4528 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4529 ++ac;
4530
4531 /* Specify the colors. */
4532 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4533 if (pixel != -1)
4534 {
4535 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4536 ++ac;
4537 }
4538 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4539 if (pixel != -1)
4540 {
4541 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4542 ++ac;
4543 }
4544 }
4545
4546 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4547 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4548
4549 {
4550 char *initial = "";
4551 char *val = initial;
4552 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4553 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4554 if (val == initial)
4555 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4556 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4557 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4558 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4559 }
4560 }
4561
4562 /* Define callbacks. */
4563 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4564 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4565 (XtPointer) bar);
4566
4567 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4568 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4569
4570 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4571
4572 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4573 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4574 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4575 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4576
4577 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4578 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4579 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4580 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4581
4582 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4583 }
4584 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4585
4586
4587 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4588 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4589
4590 #ifdef USE_GTK
4591 static void
4592 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4593 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4594 int portion, position, whole;
4595 {
4596 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4597 }
4598
4599 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4600 static void
4601 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4602 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4603 int portion, position, whole;
4604 {
4605 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4606 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4607 float top, shown;
4608
4609 BLOCK_INPUT;
4610
4611 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4612
4613 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4614 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4615 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4616 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4617 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4618 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4619 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4620 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4621 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4622 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4623 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4624 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4625 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4626 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4627 whole += portion;
4628
4629 if (whole <= 0)
4630 top = 0, shown = 1;
4631 else
4632 {
4633 top = (float) position / whole;
4634 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4635 }
4636
4637 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4638 {
4639 int size, value;
4640
4641 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4642 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4643 value. */
4644 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4645 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4646 size = max (size, 1);
4647
4648 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4649 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4650 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4651
4652 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4653 }
4654 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4655
4656 if (whole == 0)
4657 top = 0, shown = 1;
4658 else
4659 {
4660 top = (float) position / whole;
4661 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4662 }
4663
4664 {
4665 float old_top, old_shown;
4666 Dimension height;
4667 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4668 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4669 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4670 XtNheight, &height,
4671 NULL);
4672
4673 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4674 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4675 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4676 else
4677 top = old_top;
4678 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4679 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4680
4681 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4682 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4683 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4684 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4685 {
4686 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4687 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4688 else
4689 {
4690 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4691 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4692 int scroll_mode = 0;
4693
4694 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4695 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4696 {
4697 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4698 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4699 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4700 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4701 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4702 }
4703 #endif
4704 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4705 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4706 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4707
4708 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4709
4710 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4711 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4712 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4713 #endif
4714 }
4715 }
4716 }
4717 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4718
4719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4720 }
4721 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4722
4723 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4724
4725
4726 \f
4727 /************************************************************************
4728 Scroll bars, general
4729 ************************************************************************/
4730
4731 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4732 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4733 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4734 scroll bar. */
4735
4736 static struct scroll_bar *
4737 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4738 struct window *w;
4739 int top, left, width, height;
4740 {
4741 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4742 struct scroll_bar *bar
4743 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4744
4745 BLOCK_INPUT;
4746
4747 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4748 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4749 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4750 {
4751 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4752 unsigned long mask;
4753 Window window;
4754
4755 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4756 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4757 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4758
4759 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4760 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4761 | ExposureMask);
4762 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4763
4764 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4765
4766 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4767 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4768 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4769 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4770 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4771 left, top, width,
4772 window_box_height (w), False);
4773
4774 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4775 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4776 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4777 top,
4778 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4779 height,
4780 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4781 0,
4782 CopyFromParent,
4783 CopyFromParent,
4784 CopyFromParent,
4785 /* Attributes. */
4786 mask, &a);
4787 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4788 }
4789 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4790
4791 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4792 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4793 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4794 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4795 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4796 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4797 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4798 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4799
4800 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4801 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4802 bar->prev = Qnil;
4803 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4804 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4805 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4806
4807 /* Map the window/widget. */
4808 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4809 {
4810 #ifdef USE_GTK
4811 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4812 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4813 top,
4814 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4815 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4816 max (height, 1),
4817 left,
4818 width);
4819 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4820 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4821 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4822 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4823 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4824 top,
4825 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4826 max (height, 1), 0);
4827 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4828 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4829 }
4830 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4831 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4832 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4833
4834 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4835 return bar;
4836 }
4837
4838
4839 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4840
4841 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4842 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4843 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4844 events.)
4845
4846 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4847 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4848 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4849 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4850 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4851
4852 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4853
4854 static void
4855 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4856 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4857 int start, end;
4858 int rebuild;
4859 {
4860 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4861 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4862 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4863 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4864
4865 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4866 if (! rebuild
4867 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4868 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4869 return;
4870
4871 BLOCK_INPUT;
4872
4873 {
4874 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4875 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4876 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4877
4878 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4879 the distance between start and end. */
4880 {
4881 int length = end - start;
4882
4883 if (start < 0)
4884 start = 0;
4885 else if (start > top_range)
4886 start = top_range;
4887 end = start + length;
4888
4889 if (end < start)
4890 end = start;
4891 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4892 end = top_range;
4893 }
4894
4895 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4896 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4897 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4898
4899 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4900 if (end > top_range)
4901 end = top_range;
4902
4903 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4904 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4905 that many pixels tall. */
4906 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4907
4908 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4909 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4910 if (0 < start)
4911 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4912 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4913 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4914 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4915 inside_width, start,
4916 False);
4917
4918 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4919 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4920 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4921 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4922
4923 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4924 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4925 /* x, y, width, height */
4926 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4927 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4928 inside_width, end - start);
4929
4930 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4931 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4932 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4933 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4934
4935 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4936 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4937 if (end < inside_height)
4938 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4939 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4940 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4941 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4942 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4943 False);
4944
4945 }
4946
4947 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4948 }
4949
4950 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4951
4952 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4953 nil. */
4954
4955 static void
4956 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4957 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4958 {
4959 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4960 BLOCK_INPUT;
4961
4962 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4963 #ifdef USE_GTK
4964 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4965 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4966 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4967 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4968 #else
4969 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4970 #endif
4971
4972 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4973 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4974
4975 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4976 }
4977
4978
4979 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4980 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4981 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4982 create one. */
4983
4984 static void
4985 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4986 struct window *w;
4987 int portion, whole, position;
4988 {
4989 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4990 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4991 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4992 int window_y, window_height;
4993
4994 /* Get window dimensions. */
4995 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4996 top = window_y;
4997 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4998 height = window_height;
4999
5000 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5001 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5002
5003 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5004 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5005 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5006 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5007 else
5008 sb_width = width;
5009
5010 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5011 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5012 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5013 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
5014 else
5015 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
5016 #else
5017 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5018 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5019 else
5020 sb_left = left;
5021 #endif
5022
5023 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5024 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5025 {
5026 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5027 {
5028 BLOCK_INPUT;
5029 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5030 left, top, width, height, False);
5031 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5032 }
5033
5034 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5035 }
5036 else
5037 {
5038 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5039 unsigned int mask = 0;
5040
5041 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5042
5043 BLOCK_INPUT;
5044
5045 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5046 mask |= CWX;
5047 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5048 mask |= CWY;
5049 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5050 mask |= CWWidth;
5051 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5052 mask |= CWHeight;
5053
5054 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5055
5056 #ifdef USE_GTK
5057 if (mask)
5058 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5059 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5060 top,
5061 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5062 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5063 max (height, 1),
5064 left,
5065 width);
5066 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5067
5068 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5069 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5070 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5071 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5072 left, top, width, height, False);
5073 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5074 if (mask)
5075 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5076 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5077 top,
5078 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5079 max (height, 1), 0);
5080
5081 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5082 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5083
5084 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5085 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5086 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5087 {
5088 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5089 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5090 height, False);
5091 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5092 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5093 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5094 height, False);
5095 }
5096
5097 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5098 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5099 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5100 example. */
5101 {
5102 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5103 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5104 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5105 {
5106 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5107 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5108 left + area_width - rest, top,
5109 rest, height, False);
5110 else
5111 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5112 left, top, rest, height, False);
5113 }
5114 }
5115
5116 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5117 if (mask)
5118 {
5119 XWindowChanges wc;
5120
5121 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5122 wc.y = top;
5123 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5124 wc.height = height;
5125 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5126 mask, &wc);
5127 }
5128
5129 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5130
5131 /* Remember new settings. */
5132 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5133 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5134 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5135 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5136
5137 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5138 }
5139
5140 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5141 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5142 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5143 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5144 dragged. */
5145 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5146 {
5147 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5148
5149 if (whole == 0)
5150 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5151 else
5152 {
5153 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5154 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5155 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5156 }
5157 }
5158 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5159
5160 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5161 }
5162
5163
5164 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5165 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5166 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5167 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5168 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5169 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5170 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5171
5172 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5173 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5174 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5175
5176 static void
5177 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5178 FRAME_PTR frame;
5179 {
5180 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5181 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5182 {
5183 Lisp_Object bar;
5184 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5185 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5186 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5187 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5188 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5189 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5190 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5191 }
5192 }
5193
5194
5195 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5196 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5197
5198 static void
5199 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5200 struct window *window;
5201 {
5202 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5203 struct frame *f;
5204
5205 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5206 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5207 abort ();
5208
5209 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5210
5211 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5212 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5213 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5214 {
5215 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5216 the lists. */
5217 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5218 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5219 return;
5220 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5221 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5222 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5223 else
5224 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5225 one or the other! */
5226 abort ();
5227 }
5228 else
5229 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5230
5231 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5232 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5233
5234 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5235 bar->prev = Qnil;
5236 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5237 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5238 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5239 }
5240
5241 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5242 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5243
5244 static void
5245 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5246 FRAME_PTR f;
5247 {
5248 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5249
5250 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5251
5252 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5253 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5254 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5255
5256 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5257 {
5258 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5259
5260 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5261
5262 next = b->next;
5263 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5264 }
5265
5266 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5267 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5268 }
5269
5270
5271 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5272 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5273 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5274
5275 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5276 mark bits. */
5277
5278 static void
5279 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5280 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5281 XEvent *event;
5282 {
5283 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5284 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5285 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5286 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5287
5288 BLOCK_INPUT;
5289
5290 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5291
5292 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5293 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5294
5295 /* x, y, width, height */
5296 0, 0,
5297 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5298 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5299
5300 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5301
5302 }
5303 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5304
5305 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5306 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5307
5308 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5309 mark bits. */
5310
5311
5312 static void
5313 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5314 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5315 XEvent *event;
5316 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5317 {
5318 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5319 abort ();
5320
5321 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5322 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5323 emacs_event->modifiers
5324 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5325 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5326 event->xbutton.state)
5327 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5328 ? up_modifier
5329 : down_modifier));
5330 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5331 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5332 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5333 {
5334 #if 0
5335 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5336 int internal_height
5337 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5338 #endif
5339 int top_range
5340 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5341 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5342
5343 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5344 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5345
5346 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5347 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5348 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5349 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5350 else
5351 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5352
5353 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5354 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5355 whether or not we're dragging. */
5356 #if 0
5357 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5358 holding it. */
5359 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5360 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5361 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5362 #endif
5363
5364 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5365 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5366 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5367 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5368 {
5369 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5370 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5371
5372 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5374 }
5375 #endif
5376
5377 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5378 #if 0
5379 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5380 the handle. */
5381 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5382 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5383 else
5384 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5385 #else
5386 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5387 #endif
5388
5389 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5390 }
5391 }
5392
5393 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5394
5395 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5396
5397 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5398 mark bits. */
5399
5400 static void
5401 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5402 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5403 XEvent *event;
5404 {
5405 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5406
5407 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5408
5409 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5410 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5411
5412 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5413 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5414 {
5415 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5416 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5417
5418 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5419 {
5420 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5421
5422 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5423 }
5424 }
5425 }
5426
5427 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5428
5429 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5430 on the scroll bar. */
5431
5432 static void
5433 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5434 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5435 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5436 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5437 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5438 unsigned long *time;
5439 {
5440 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5441 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5442 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5443 int win_x, win_y;
5444 Window dummy_window;
5445 int dummy_coord;
5446 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5447
5448 BLOCK_INPUT;
5449
5450 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5451 report that. */
5452 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5453
5454 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5455 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5456 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5457
5458 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5459 &win_x, &win_y,
5460
5461 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5462 &dummy_mask))
5463 ;
5464 else
5465 {
5466 #if 0
5467 int inside_height
5468 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5469 #endif
5470 int top_range
5471 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5472
5473 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5474
5475 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5476 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5477
5478 if (win_y < 0)
5479 win_y = 0;
5480 if (win_y > top_range)
5481 win_y = top_range;
5482
5483 *fp = f;
5484 *bar_window = bar->window;
5485
5486 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5487 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5488 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5489 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5490 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5491 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5492 else
5493 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5494
5495 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5496 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5497
5498 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5499 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5500 }
5501
5502 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5503
5504 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5505 }
5506
5507
5508 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5509 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5510 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5511 redraw them. */
5512
5513 void
5514 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5515 FRAME_PTR f;
5516 {
5517 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5518 Lisp_Object bar;
5519
5520 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5521 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5522 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5523 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5524 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5525 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5526 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5527 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5528 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5529 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5530 }
5531
5532 \f
5533 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
5534
5535 struct selection_event_queue
5536 {
5537 XEvent event;
5538 struct selection_event_queue *next;
5539 };
5540
5541 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
5542
5543 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
5544
5545 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
5546
5547 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
5548
5549 static void
5550 x_queue_event (f, event)
5551 FRAME_PTR f;
5552 XEvent *event;
5553 {
5554 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
5555 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
5556
5557 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
5558 {
5559 queue_tmp->event = *event;
5560 queue_tmp->next = queue;
5561 queue = queue_tmp;
5562 }
5563 }
5564
5565 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
5566 so that they get processed afresh. */
5567
5568 static void
5569 x_unqueue_events (display)
5570 Display *display;
5571 {
5572 while (queue != NULL)
5573 {
5574 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
5575 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
5576 queue = queue_tmp->next;
5577 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
5578 }
5579 }
5580
5581 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5582
5583 void
5584 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5585 Display *display;
5586 {
5587 x_queue_selection_requests++;
5588 }
5589
5590 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5591
5592 void
5593 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5594 Display *display;
5595 {
5596 x_queue_selection_requests--;
5597 x_unqueue_events (display);
5598 }
5599 \f
5600 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5601
5602 #if 0
5603 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5604 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5605 sometimes don't work. */
5606
5607 static Time enter_timestamp;
5608 #endif
5609
5610 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5611 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5612 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5613 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5614
5615 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5616 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5617
5618 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5619
5620 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5621 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5622
5623 static int temp_index;
5624 static short temp_buffer[100];
5625
5626 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5627 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5628 temp_index = 0; \
5629 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5630
5631 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5632 on a particular display. */
5633
5634 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5635
5636 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5637 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5638 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5639 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5640
5641 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5642
5643 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5644 do \
5645 { \
5646 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5647 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5648 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5649 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5650 inev.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5651 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f); \
5652 } \
5653 while (0)
5654
5655 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5656 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5657
5658
5659 enum
5660 {
5661 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5662 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5663 X_EVENT_DROP
5664 };
5665
5666 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5667 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5668 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5669
5670 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5671 this event further.
5672 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5673
5674 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5675 static int
5676 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5677 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5678 XEvent *event;
5679 {
5680 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5681 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5682 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5683 was created. */
5684
5685 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5686 event->xclient.window);
5687
5688 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5689 }
5690 #endif
5691
5692 #ifdef USE_GTK
5693 static int current_count;
5694 static int current_finish;
5695 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5696
5697 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5698 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5699 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5700 static GdkFilterReturn
5701 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5702 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5703 GdkEvent *ev;
5704 gpointer data;
5705 {
5706 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5707
5708 if (current_count >= 0)
5709 {
5710 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5711
5712 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5713
5714 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5715 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5716 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5717 so we do it here. */
5718 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5719 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5720 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5721 #endif
5722
5723 if (! dpyinfo)
5724 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5725 else
5726 {
5727 current_count +=
5728 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5729 current_hold_quit);
5730 }
5731 }
5732 else
5733 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5734
5735 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5736 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5737
5738 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5739 }
5740 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5741
5742
5743 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5744
5745 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5746 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5747 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5748
5749 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5750
5751 static int
5752 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5753 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5754 XEvent *eventp;
5755 int *finish;
5756 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5757 {
5758 struct input_event inev;
5759 int count = 0;
5760 int do_help = 0;
5761 int nbytes = 0;
5762 struct frame *f;
5763 struct coding_system coding;
5764 XEvent event = *eventp;
5765
5766 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5767
5768 EVENT_INIT (inev);
5769 inev.kind = NO_EVENT;
5770 inev.arg = Qnil;
5771
5772 switch (event.type)
5773 {
5774 case ClientMessage:
5775 {
5776 if (event.xclient.message_type
5777 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5778 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5779 {
5780 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5781 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5782 {
5783 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5784 could be the shell widget window
5785 if the frame has no title bar. */
5786 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5787 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5788 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5789 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5790 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5791 #endif
5792 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5793 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5794 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5795 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5796 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5797 needed.
5798
5799 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5800 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5801 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5802 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5803 Emacs. */
5804
5805 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5806 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5807 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5808 if (f)
5809 {
5810 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5811 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5812 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5813 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5814 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5815 /* The ICCCM says this is
5816 the only valid choice. */
5817 RevertToParent,
5818 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5819 /* This is needed to detect the error
5820 if there is an error. */
5821 XSync (d, False);
5822 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5823 }
5824 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5825 #endif /* 0 */
5826 goto done;
5827 }
5828
5829 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5830 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5831 {
5832 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5833 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5834 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5835 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5836 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5837 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5838 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5839 session manager and one for this. */
5840 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5841 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5842 #endif
5843 {
5844 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5845 event.xclient.window);
5846 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5847 for a single Emacs process. */
5848 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5849 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5850 event.xclient.window,
5851 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5852 else if (f)
5853 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5854 event.xclient.window,
5855 0, 0);
5856 }
5857 goto done;
5858 }
5859
5860 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5861 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5862 {
5863 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5864 event.xclient.window);
5865 if (!f)
5866 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5867
5868 inev.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5869 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
5870 goto done;
5871 }
5872
5873 goto done;
5874 }
5875
5876 if (event.xclient.message_type
5877 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5878 {
5879 goto done;
5880 }
5881
5882 if (event.xclient.message_type
5883 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5884 {
5885 int new_x, new_y;
5886 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5887
5888 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5889 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5890
5891 if (f)
5892 {
5893 f->left_pos = new_x;
5894 f->top_pos = new_y;
5895 }
5896 goto done;
5897 }
5898
5899 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5900 if (event.xclient.message_type
5901 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5902 {
5903 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5904 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5905 &event, NULL);
5906 goto done;
5907 }
5908 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5909
5910 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5911 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5912 || (event.xclient.message_type
5913 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5914 {
5915 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5916 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5917 currently never do because we are interested in
5918 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5919 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5920 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5921 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5922 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5923 goto done;
5924 }
5925
5926 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5927 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5928 we construct an input_event. */
5929 if (event.xclient.message_type
5930 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5931 {
5932 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev);
5933 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5934 goto done;
5935 }
5936 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5937
5938 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5939
5940 if (!f)
5941 goto OTHER;
5942
5943 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev))
5944 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5945 }
5946 break;
5947
5948 case SelectionNotify:
5949 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5950 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5951 goto OTHER;
5952 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5953 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5954 break;
5955
5956 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5957 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5958 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5959 goto OTHER;
5960 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5961 {
5962 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5963
5964 inev.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5965 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5966 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5967 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5968 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5969 }
5970 break;
5971
5972 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5973 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5974 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5975 goto OTHER;
5976 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5977 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
5978 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
5979 &event);
5980 else
5981 {
5982 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5983 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5984
5985 inev.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5986 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5987 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev) = eventp->requestor;
5988 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5989 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev) = eventp->target;
5990 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev) = eventp->property;
5991 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5992 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5993 }
5994 break;
5995
5996 case PropertyNotify:
5997 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5998 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5999 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
6000 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
6001 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
6002 goto OTHER;
6003 #endif
6004 #endif
6005 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6006 goto OTHER;
6007
6008 case ReparentNotify:
6009 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6010 if (f)
6011 {
6012 int x, y;
6013 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6014 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6015 f->left_pos = x;
6016 f->top_pos = y;
6017
6018 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6019 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6020 }
6021 goto OTHER;
6022
6023 case Expose:
6024 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6025 if (f)
6026 {
6027 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6028
6029 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6030 {
6031 f->async_visible = 1;
6032 f->async_iconified = 0;
6033 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6034 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6035 }
6036 else
6037 expose_frame (f,
6038 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6039 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6040 }
6041 else
6042 {
6043 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6044 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6045 #endif
6046 #if defined USE_LUCID
6047 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6048 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6049 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6050 {
6051 Widget widget
6052 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6053 if (widget)
6054 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6055 }
6056 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6057
6058 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6059 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6060 goto OTHER;
6061 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6062 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6063 event.xexpose.window);
6064
6065 if (bar)
6066 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6067 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6068 else
6069 goto OTHER;
6070 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6071 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6072 }
6073 break;
6074
6075 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6076 source area was obscured or not
6077 available. */
6078 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6079 if (f)
6080 {
6081 expose_frame (f,
6082 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6083 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6084 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6085 }
6086 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6087 else
6088 goto OTHER;
6089 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6090 break;
6091
6092 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6093 source area was completely
6094 available. */
6095 break;
6096
6097 case UnmapNotify:
6098 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6099 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6100 {
6101 tip_window = 0;
6102 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6103 }
6104
6105 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6106 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6107 the frame was deleted. */
6108 {
6109 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6110 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6111 display that won't ever be seen. */
6112 f->async_visible = 0;
6113 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6114 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6115 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6116 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6117 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6118 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6119 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6120 {
6121 f->async_iconified = 1;
6122
6123 inev.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6124 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6125 }
6126 }
6127 goto OTHER;
6128
6129 case MapNotify:
6130 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6131 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6132 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6133 goto OTHER;
6134
6135 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6136 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6137 frame is visible. */
6138 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6139 if (f)
6140 {
6141 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
6142 the frame's display structures.
6143 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6144 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6145 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6146 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6147 if (! f->async_iconified)
6148 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6149
6150 f->async_visible = 1;
6151 f->async_iconified = 0;
6152 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6153
6154 if (f->iconified)
6155 {
6156 inev.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6157 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6158 }
6159 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6160 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6161 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6162 to update the frame titles
6163 in case this is the second frame. */
6164 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6165 }
6166 goto OTHER;
6167
6168 case KeyPress:
6169
6170 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6171 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6172 if (popup_activated ())
6173 goto OTHER;
6174 #endif
6175
6176 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6177
6178 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6179 {
6180 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6181 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6182 }
6183
6184 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6185 if (f == 0)
6186 {
6187 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6188 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6189 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6190 event.xkey.window);
6191 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6192 {
6193 widget = XtParent (widget);
6194 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6195 }
6196 }
6197 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6198
6199 if (f != 0)
6200 {
6201 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6202 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6203 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6204 his Emacs hang.
6205
6206 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6207 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6208 status_return even if the input is too long to
6209 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6210 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6211 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6212 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6213 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6214 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6215 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6216 int modifiers;
6217 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6218 Lisp_Object c;
6219
6220 event.xkey.state
6221 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6222 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6223 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6224
6225 /* This will have to go some day... */
6226
6227 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6228 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6229 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6230 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6231 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6232 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6233 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6234
6235 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6236 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6237 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6238 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6239 not it is combined with Meta. */
6240 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6241 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6242
6243 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6244 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6245 {
6246 Status status_return;
6247
6248 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6249 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6250 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6251 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6252 &status_return);
6253 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6254 {
6255 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6256 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6257 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6258 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6259 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6260 &status_return);
6261 }
6262 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6263 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6264 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6265 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6266 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6267 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6268 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6269 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6270 &status_return);
6271 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6272 {
6273 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6274 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6275 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6276 &event.xkey,
6277 copy_bufptr,
6278 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6279 &status_return);
6280 }
6281 }
6282 #endif
6283
6284 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6285 break;
6286 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6287 {
6288 keysym = NoSymbol;
6289 modifiers = 0;
6290 }
6291 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6292 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6293 abort ();
6294 }
6295 else
6296 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6297 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6298 &compose_status);
6299 #else
6300 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6301 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6302 &compose_status);
6303 #endif
6304
6305 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6306 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6307 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6308 break;
6309
6310 orig_keysym = keysym;
6311
6312 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6313 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6314 inev.modifiers
6315 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6316 inev.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6317
6318 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6319 translations to characters. */
6320 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6321 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6322 {
6323 inev.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6324 inev.code = keysym;
6325 goto done_keysym;
6326 }
6327
6328 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6329 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6330 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6331 Vx_keysym_table,
6332 Qnil))))
6333 {
6334 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6335 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6336 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6337 inev.code = XFASTINT (c);
6338 goto done_keysym;
6339 }
6340
6341 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6342 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6343 || keysym == XK_Delete
6344 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6345 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6346 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6347 #endif
6348 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6349 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6350 #ifdef HPUX
6351 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6352 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6353 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6354 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6355 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6356 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6357 #endif
6358 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6359 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6360 #endif
6361 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6362 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6363 #endif
6364 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6365 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6366 #endif
6367 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6368 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6369 #endif
6370 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6371 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6372 #endif
6373 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6374 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6375 #endif
6376 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6377 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6378 #endif
6379 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6380 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6381 #endif
6382 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6383 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6384 #endif
6385 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6386 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6387 #endif
6388 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6389 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6390 #endif
6391 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6392 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6393 #endif
6394 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6395 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6396 #endif
6397 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6398 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6399 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6400 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6401 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6402 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6403 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6404 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6405 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6406 #endif
6407 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6408 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6409 #endif
6410 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6411 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6412 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6413 don't have real modifiers but
6414 should be treated similarly to
6415 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6416 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6417 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6418 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6419 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6420 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6421 #endif
6422 ))
6423 {
6424 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6425 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6426 key. */
6427 inev.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6428 inev.code = keysym;
6429 goto done_keysym;
6430 }
6431
6432 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6433 register int i;
6434 register int c;
6435 int nchars, len;
6436
6437 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6438 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6439 we used just above and the locale. */
6440 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6441 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6442 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6443 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6444 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6445 gives us composition information. */
6446 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6447
6448 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6449 {
6450 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6451 }
6452
6453 {
6454 /* Decode the input data. */
6455 int require;
6456 unsigned char *p;
6457
6458 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6459 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6460 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6461 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6462 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6463 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6464 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6465 nbytes = coding.produced;
6466 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6467 copy_bufptr = p;
6468 }
6469
6470 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6471 character events. */
6472 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6473 {
6474 if (nchars == nbytes)
6475 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6476 else
6477 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6478 nbytes - i, len);
6479 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6480 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6481 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6482 inev.code = c;
6483 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6484 }
6485
6486 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6487 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6488 count += nbytes;
6489
6490 inev.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6491
6492 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6493 break;
6494 }
6495 }
6496 done_keysym:
6497 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6498 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6499 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6500 client. */
6501 break;
6502 #else
6503 goto OTHER;
6504 #endif
6505
6506 case KeyRelease:
6507 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6508 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6509 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6510 client. */
6511 break;
6512 #else
6513 goto OTHER;
6514 #endif
6515
6516 case EnterNotify:
6517 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6518
6519 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6520
6521 #if 0
6522 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6523 {
6524 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6525 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6526 || !(f->auto_lower)
6527 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6528 {
6529 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6530 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6531 }
6532 }
6533 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6534 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6535 #endif
6536
6537 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6538 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6539 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6540 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6541 goto OTHER;
6542
6543 case FocusIn:
6544 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6545 goto OTHER;
6546
6547 case LeaveNotify:
6548 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6549
6550 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6551 if (f)
6552 {
6553 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6554 {
6555 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6556 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6557 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6558 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6559 }
6560
6561 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6562 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6563 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6564 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6565 if (any_help_event_p)
6566 do_help = -1;
6567 }
6568 goto OTHER;
6569
6570 case FocusOut:
6571 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6572 goto OTHER;
6573
6574 case MotionNotify:
6575 {
6576 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6577 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6578 help_echo_pos = -1;
6579
6580 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6581 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6582 f = last_mouse_frame;
6583 else
6584 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6585
6586 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6587 {
6588 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6589 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6590 }
6591
6592 if (f)
6593 {
6594
6595 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6596 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6597 {
6598 Lisp_Object window;
6599
6600 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6601 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6602 0, 0, 0, 0);
6603
6604 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6605 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6606 will be selected iff it is active. */
6607 if (WINDOWP (window)
6608 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6609 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6610 {
6611 inev.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6612 inev.frame_or_window = window;
6613 }
6614
6615 last_window=window;
6616 }
6617 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6618 }
6619 else
6620 {
6621 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6622 struct scroll_bar *bar
6623 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6624 event.xmotion.window);
6625
6626 if (bar)
6627 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6628 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6629
6630 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6631 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6632 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6633 }
6634
6635 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6636 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6637 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6638 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6639 do_help = 1;
6640 goto OTHER;
6641 }
6642
6643 case ConfigureNotify:
6644 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6645 if (f)
6646 {
6647 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6648 #ifdef USE_GTK
6649 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6650 event.xconfigure.height);
6651 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6652 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6653 do this one, the right one will come later.
6654 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6655 need to reset it below. */
6656 int dont_resize
6657 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6658 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6659 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6660 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6661
6662 if (dont_resize)
6663 goto OTHER;
6664
6665 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6666 is called by the code that handles resizing
6667 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6668
6669 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6670 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6671 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6672 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6673 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6674 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6675 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6676 {
6677 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6678 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6679 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6680 }
6681 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6682 #endif
6683
6684 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6685 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6686
6687 #ifdef USE_GTK
6688 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6689 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6690 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6691 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6692 #endif
6693 {
6694 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6695 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6696 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6697
6698 x_check_expected_move (f);
6699 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6700 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6701 }
6702
6703 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6704 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6705 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6706 #endif
6707
6708 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6709 {
6710 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6711 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6712 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6713 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6714 }
6715 }
6716 goto OTHER;
6717
6718 case ButtonRelease:
6719 case ButtonPress:
6720 {
6721 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6722 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6723 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6724
6725 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6726
6727 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6728 && last_mouse_frame
6729 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6730 f = last_mouse_frame;
6731 else
6732 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6733
6734 if (f)
6735 {
6736 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6737 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6738 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6739 {
6740 Lisp_Object window;
6741 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6742 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6743
6744 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6745 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6746 {
6747 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6748 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6749 else
6750 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6751 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6752 event.xbutton.state));
6753 tool_bar_p = 1;
6754 }
6755 }
6756
6757 if (!tool_bar_p)
6758 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6759 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6760 {
6761 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6762 if (! popup_activated ())
6763 #endif
6764 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6765 }
6766 }
6767 else
6768 {
6769 struct scroll_bar *bar
6770 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6771 event.xbutton.window);
6772
6773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6774 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6775 scroll bars. */
6776 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6777 {
6778 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6779 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6780 }
6781 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6782 if (bar)
6783 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6784 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6785 }
6786
6787 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6788 {
6789 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6790 last_mouse_frame = f;
6791 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6792 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6793 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6794 the ButtonPress. */
6795 if (f != 0)
6796 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6797
6798 if (!tool_bar_p)
6799 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6800 }
6801 else
6802 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6803
6804 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6805 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6806 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6807 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6808 Instead, save it away
6809 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6810 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6811 if (
6812 #ifdef USE_GTK
6813 ! popup_activated ()
6814 &&
6815 #endif
6816 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6817 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6818 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6819 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6820 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6821 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6822 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6823 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6824 {
6825 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6826 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6827 #ifdef USE_GTK
6828 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6829 #endif
6830 }
6831 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6832 {
6833 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6834 goto OTHER;
6835 }
6836
6837 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6838 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6839 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6840 {
6841 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6842 {
6843 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6844 if (f->output_data.x)
6845 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6846 }
6847 else
6848 goto OTHER;
6849 }
6850 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6851 else
6852 goto OTHER;
6853 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6854 }
6855 break;
6856
6857 case CirculateNotify:
6858 goto OTHER;
6859
6860 case CirculateRequest:
6861 goto OTHER;
6862
6863 case VisibilityNotify:
6864 goto OTHER;
6865
6866 case MappingNotify:
6867 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6868 local cache. */
6869 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6870 {
6871 case MappingModifier:
6872 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6873 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6874 case MappingKeyboard:
6875 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6876 }
6877 goto OTHER;
6878
6879 default:
6880 OTHER:
6881 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6882 BLOCK_INPUT;
6883 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6884 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6885 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6886 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6887 break;
6888 }
6889
6890 done:
6891 if (inev.kind != NO_EVENT)
6892 {
6893 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6894 count++;
6895 }
6896
6897 if (do_help
6898 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6899 {
6900 Lisp_Object frame;
6901
6902 if (f)
6903 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6904 else
6905 frame = Qnil;
6906
6907 if (do_help > 0)
6908 {
6909 any_help_event_p = 1;
6910 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6911 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6912 }
6913 else
6914 {
6915 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6916 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6917 }
6918 count++;
6919 }
6920
6921 *eventp = event;
6922 return count;
6923 }
6924
6925
6926 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6927 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6928 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6929
6930 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6931 int
6932 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6933 XEvent *event;
6934 Display *display;
6935 {
6936 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6937 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6938
6939 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6940
6941 if (dpyinfo)
6942 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6943
6944 return finish;
6945 }
6946
6947
6948 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6949 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6950 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6951
6952 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6953 thus pretending to be `read'.
6954
6955 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6956
6957 static int
6958 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6959 register int sd;
6960 int expected;
6961 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6962 {
6963 int count = 0;
6964 XEvent event;
6965 int event_found = 0;
6966 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6967
6968 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6969 {
6970 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6971 return -1;
6972 }
6973
6974 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6975 BLOCK_INPUT;
6976
6977 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6978 input_signal_count++;
6979
6980 ++handling_signal;
6981
6982 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6983 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6984 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6985 {
6986 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6987 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6988 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6989 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6990 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6991 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6992 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6993 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6994 #endif
6995
6996 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6997 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6998 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
6999 for X connections. */
7000 #ifndef SIGIO
7001 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7002 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7003 {
7004 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7005 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7006 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7007 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7008 }
7009 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7010 #endif /* SIGIO */
7011 #endif
7012
7013 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7014 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7015 {
7016 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7017 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7018 }
7019
7020 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7021 {
7022 struct input_event inev;
7023 BLOCK_INPUT;
7024 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7025 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7026 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7027 {
7028 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7029 count++;
7030 }
7031 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7032 }
7033 #endif
7034
7035 #ifndef USE_GTK
7036 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7037 {
7038 int finish;
7039
7040 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7041
7042 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7043 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7044 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7045 break;
7046 #endif
7047 event_found = 1;
7048
7049 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7050
7051 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7052 goto out;
7053 }
7054 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7055 }
7056
7057 #ifdef USE_GTK
7058
7059 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7060 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7061 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7062 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7063
7064 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7065 from all displays. */
7066
7067 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7068 {
7069 current_count = count;
7070 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7071
7072 gtk_main_iteration ();
7073
7074 count = current_count;
7075 current_count = -1;
7076 current_hold_quit = 0;
7077
7078 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7079 break;
7080 }
7081 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7082
7083 out:;
7084
7085 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7086 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7087 if (! event_found)
7088 {
7089 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7090 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7091 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7092 x_noop_count++;
7093 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7094 {
7095 x_noop_count=0;
7096
7097 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7098 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7099
7100 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7101
7102 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7103 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7104 }
7105 }
7106
7107 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7108 raise it now. */
7109 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7110 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7111 {
7112 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7113 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7114 }
7115
7116 --handling_signal;
7117 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7118
7119 return count;
7120 }
7121
7122
7123
7124 \f
7125 /***********************************************************************
7126 Text Cursor
7127 ***********************************************************************/
7128
7129 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7130 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7131
7132 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7133 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7134 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7135
7136 static void
7137 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc)
7138 struct window *w;
7139 struct glyph_row *row;
7140 GC gc;
7141 {
7142 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7143 XRectangle clip_rect;
7144 int window_y, window_width;
7145
7146 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7147
7148 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
7149 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7150 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7151 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7152 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7153
7154 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7155 }
7156
7157
7158 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7159
7160 static void
7161 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7162 struct window *w;
7163 struct glyph_row *row;
7164 {
7165 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7166 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7167 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7168 int x, y, wd, h;
7169 XGCValues xgcv;
7170 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7171 GC gc;
7172
7173 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7174 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7175 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7176 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7177 return;
7178
7179 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7180 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7181 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7182 width instead. */
7183 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7184 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7185 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7186 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7187 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7188
7189 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7190 coordinates. */
7191 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7192 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y);
7193
7194 /* Compute the proper height and ascent of the rectangle, based
7195 on the actual glyph. Using the full height of the row looks
7196 bad when there are tall images on that row. */
7197 h = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), cursor_glyph->ascent + cursor_glyph->descent);
7198 if (h < row->height)
7199 y += row->ascent /* - w->phys_cursor_ascent */ + cursor_glyph->descent - h;
7200 h--;
7201
7202 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7203 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7204 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7205 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7206 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7207 else
7208 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7209 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7210 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7211
7212 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7213 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7214 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7215 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7216 }
7217
7218
7219 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7220
7221 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7222 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7223 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7224 --gerd. */
7225
7226 static void
7227 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7228 struct window *w;
7229 struct glyph_row *row;
7230 int width;
7231 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7232 {
7233 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7234 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7235
7236 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7237 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7238 and mini-buffer. */
7239 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7240 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7241 return;
7242
7243 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7244 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7245 the bar might not be in the window. */
7246 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7247 {
7248 struct glyph_row *row;
7249 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7250 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7251 }
7252 else
7253 {
7254 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7255 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7256 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7257 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7258 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7259 XGCValues xgcv;
7260
7261 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7262 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7263 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7264 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7265 that the glyph is legible. */
7266 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7267 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7268 else
7269 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7270 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7271
7272 if (gc)
7273 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7274 else
7275 {
7276 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7277 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7278 }
7279
7280 if (width < 0)
7281 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7282 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7283
7284 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7285 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7286
7287 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7288 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7289 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7290 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7291 width, row->height);
7292 else
7293 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7294 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7295 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7296 row->height - width),
7297 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7298 width);
7299
7300 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7301 }
7302 }
7303
7304
7305 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7306
7307 static void
7308 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7309 struct frame *f;
7310 Cursor cursor;
7311 {
7312 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7313 }
7314
7315
7316 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7317
7318 static void
7319 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7320 struct frame *f;
7321 int x, y, width, height;
7322 {
7323 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7324 x, y, width, height, False);
7325 }
7326
7327
7328 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7329
7330 static void
7331 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7332 struct window *w;
7333 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7334 int x, y;
7335 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7336 int on_p, active_p;
7337 {
7338 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7339
7340 if (on_p)
7341 {
7342 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7343 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7344
7345 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7346 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7347 {
7348 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7349 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7350 }
7351 else
7352 switch (cursor_type)
7353 {
7354 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7355 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7356 break;
7357
7358 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7359 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7360 break;
7361
7362 case BAR_CURSOR:
7363 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7364 break;
7365
7366 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7367 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7368 break;
7369
7370 case NO_CURSOR:
7371 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7372 break;
7373
7374 default:
7375 abort ();
7376 }
7377
7378 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7379 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7380 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7381 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7382 #endif
7383 }
7384
7385 #ifndef XFlush
7386 if (updating_frame != f)
7387 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7388 #endif
7389 }
7390
7391 \f
7392 /* Icons. */
7393
7394 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7395
7396 int
7397 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7398 struct frame *f;
7399 Lisp_Object file;
7400 {
7401 int bitmap_id;
7402
7403 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7404 return 1;
7405
7406 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7407 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7408 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7409 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7410
7411 if (STRINGP (file))
7412 {
7413 #ifdef USE_GTK
7414 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7415 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7416 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7417 return 0;
7418 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7419 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7420 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7421 }
7422 else
7423 {
7424 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7425 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7426 {
7427 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7428 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7429 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7430 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7431 }
7432
7433 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7434 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7435 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7436 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7437 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7438
7439 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7440 }
7441
7442 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7443 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7444
7445 return 0;
7446 }
7447
7448
7449 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7450 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7451
7452 int
7453 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7454 struct frame *f;
7455 char *icon_name;
7456 {
7457 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7458 return 1;
7459
7460 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7461 {
7462 XTextProperty text;
7463 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7464 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7465 text.format = 8;
7466 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7467 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7468 }
7469 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7470 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7471 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7472
7473 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7474 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7475 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7476 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7477
7478 return 0;
7479 }
7480 \f
7481 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7482
7483 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7484 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7485
7486 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7487
7488 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7489 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7490 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7491
7492 static void
7493 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7494 Display *display;
7495 XErrorEvent *error;
7496 {
7497 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7498 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7499 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7500 }
7501
7502 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7503 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7504 operating on.
7505
7506 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7507 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7508 stored in x_error_message_string.
7509
7510 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7511 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7512
7513 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7514
7515 void x_check_errors ();
7516 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7517
7518 int
7519 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7520 Display *dpy;
7521 {
7522 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7523
7524 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7525 XSync (dpy, False);
7526
7527 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7528 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7529 x_error_message_string));
7530
7531 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7532 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7533
7534 return count;
7535 }
7536
7537 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7538
7539 static Lisp_Object
7540 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7541 Lisp_Object old_val;
7542 {
7543 Lisp_Object first;
7544
7545 first = XCAR (old_val);
7546
7547 XSync (XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer, False);
7548
7549 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7550 return Qnil;
7551 }
7552
7553 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7554 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7555 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7556
7557 void
7558 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7559 Display *dpy;
7560 char *format;
7561 {
7562 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7563 XSync (dpy, False);
7564
7565 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7566 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7567 }
7568
7569 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7570 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7571
7572 int
7573 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7574 Display *dpy;
7575 {
7576 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7577 XSync (dpy, False);
7578
7579 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7580 }
7581
7582 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7583
7584 void
7585 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7586 Display *dpy;
7587 {
7588 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7589 }
7590
7591 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7592 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7593 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7594 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7595
7596 void
7597 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7598 Display *dpy;
7599 int count;
7600 {
7601 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7602 }
7603
7604 #if 0
7605 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7606 x_trace_wire ()
7607 {
7608 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7609 }
7610 #endif /* ! 0 */
7611
7612 \f
7613 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7614 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7615 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7616 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7617 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7618
7619 static SIGTYPE
7620 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7621 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7622 {
7623 #ifdef USG
7624 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7625 must reestablish each time */
7626 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7627 #endif /* USG */
7628 }
7629
7630 \f
7631 /************************************************************************
7632 Handling X errors
7633 ************************************************************************/
7634
7635 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7636
7637 static char *error_msg;
7638
7639 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7640 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7641 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7642
7643 static void
7644 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7645 {
7646 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7647 exit (70);
7648 }
7649
7650 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7651 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7652
7653 static SIGTYPE
7654 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7655 Display *dpy;
7656 char *error_message;
7657 {
7658 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7659 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7660 int count;
7661
7662 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7663 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7664 handling_signal = 0;
7665
7666 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7667 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7668 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7669 the original message here. */
7670 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7671
7672 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7673 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7674 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7675
7676 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7677 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7678 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7679
7680 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7681 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7682
7683 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7684 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7685 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7686
7687 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7688 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7689 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7690 if (dpyinfo)
7691 {
7692 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7693 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7694 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7695 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7696 }
7697 #endif
7698
7699 #ifdef USE_GTK
7700 if (dpyinfo)
7701 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7702 #endif
7703
7704 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7705 if (dpyinfo)
7706 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7707
7708 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7709 that are on the dead display. */
7710 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7711 {
7712 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7713 minibuf_frame
7714 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7715 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7716 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7717 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7718 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7719 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7720 }
7721
7722 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7723 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7724 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7725 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7726 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7727 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7728 {
7729 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7730 trying to find a replacement. */
7731 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7732 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7733 }
7734
7735 if (dpyinfo)
7736 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7737
7738 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7739
7740 if (x_display_list == 0)
7741 {
7742 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7743 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7744 exit (70);
7745 }
7746
7747 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7748 #ifdef SIGIO
7749 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7750 #endif
7751 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7752 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7753
7754 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7755 error ("%s", error_msg);
7756 }
7757
7758
7759 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7760 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7761 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7762
7763 static void
7764 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7765 Display *display;
7766 XErrorEvent *error;
7767 {
7768 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7769
7770 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7771 original error handler. */
7772
7773 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7774 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7775 buf, error->request_code);
7776 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7777 }
7778
7779
7780 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7781 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7782
7783 static int
7784 x_error_handler (display, error)
7785 Display *display;
7786 XErrorEvent *error;
7787 {
7788 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7789 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7790 else
7791 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7792 return 0;
7793 }
7794
7795 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7796 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7797 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7798
7799 static int
7800 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7801 Display *display;
7802 {
7803 char buf[256];
7804
7805 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7806 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7807 return 0;
7808 }
7809 \f
7810 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7811
7812 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7813 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7814 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7815 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7816
7817 Lisp_Object
7818 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7819 struct frame *f;
7820 register char *fontname;
7821 {
7822 struct font_info *fontp
7823 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7824
7825 if (!fontp)
7826 return Qnil;
7827
7828 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7829 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7830 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7831
7832 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (f));
7833 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7834
7835 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7836
7837 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7838 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7839 {
7840 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7841 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7842 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7843 }
7844 else
7845 {
7846 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7847 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7848 }
7849
7850 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7851 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7852 {
7853 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7854 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7855 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7856 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7857 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7858 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7859
7860 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7861 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7862 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7863 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7864 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7865 }
7866
7867 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7868 }
7869
7870 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7871 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7872 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7873 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7874
7875 Lisp_Object
7876 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7877 struct frame *f;
7878 char *fontsetname;
7879 {
7880 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7881 Lisp_Object result;
7882
7883 if (fontset < 0)
7884 return Qnil;
7885
7886 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7887 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7888 to do. */
7889 return fontset_name (fontset);
7890
7891 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7892
7893 if (!STRINGP (result))
7894 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7895 return Qnil;
7896
7897 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7898 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7899
7900 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7901 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7902 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7903 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7904 #endif
7905
7906 return build_string (fontsetname);
7907 }
7908
7909 \f
7910 /***********************************************************************
7911 X Input Methods
7912 ***********************************************************************/
7913
7914 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7915
7916 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7917
7918 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7919 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7920 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7921
7922 static void
7923 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7924 XIM xim;
7925 XPointer client_data;
7926 XPointer call_data;
7927 {
7928 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7929 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7930
7931 BLOCK_INPUT;
7932
7933 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7934 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7935 {
7936 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7937 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7938 {
7939 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7940 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
7941 {
7942 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
7943 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
7944 }
7945 }
7946 }
7947
7948 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7949 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7950 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7951 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7952 }
7953
7954 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7955
7956 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7957 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7958 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7959 #endif
7960
7961 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7962 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7963
7964 static void
7965 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7966 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7967 char *resource_name;
7968 {
7969 XIM xim;
7970
7971 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7972 if (use_xim)
7973 {
7974 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7975 EMACS_CLASS);
7976 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7977
7978 if (xim)
7979 {
7980 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7981 XIMCallback destroy;
7982 #endif
7983
7984 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7985 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7986
7987 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7988 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7989 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7990 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7991 #endif
7992 }
7993 }
7994
7995 else
7996 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7997 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7998 }
7999
8000
8001 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8002
8003 struct xim_inst_t
8004 {
8005 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8006 char *resource_name;
8007 };
8008
8009 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8010 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8011 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8012 when the callback was registered. */
8013
8014 static void
8015 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8016 Display *display;
8017 XPointer client_data;
8018 XPointer call_data;
8019 {
8020 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8021 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8022
8023 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8024 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8025 return;
8026
8027 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8028
8029 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8030 as they have no XIC. */
8031 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8032 {
8033 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8034
8035 BLOCK_INPUT;
8036 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8037 {
8038 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8039
8040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8041 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8042 {
8043 create_frame_xic (f);
8044 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8045 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8046 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8047 {
8048 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8049 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8050 }
8051 }
8052 }
8053
8054 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8055 }
8056 }
8057
8058 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8059
8060
8061 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8062 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8063 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8064 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8065
8066 static void
8067 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8068 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8069 char *resource_name;
8070 {
8071 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8072 if (use_xim)
8073 {
8074 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8075 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8076 int len;
8077
8078 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8079 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8080 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8081 len = strlen (resource_name);
8082 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8083 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8084 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8085 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8086 xim_instantiate_callback,
8087 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8088 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8089 least, hence the configure test. */
8090 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8091 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8092 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8093 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8094 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8095
8096 }
8097 else
8098 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8099 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8100 }
8101
8102
8103 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8104
8105 static void
8106 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8107 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8108 {
8109 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8110 if (use_xim)
8111 {
8112 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8113 if (dpyinfo->display)
8114 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8115 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8116 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8117 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8118 if (dpyinfo->display)
8119 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8120 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8121 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8122 }
8123 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8124 }
8125
8126 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8127
8128
8129 \f
8130 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8131 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8132
8133 void
8134 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8135 struct frame *f;
8136 {
8137 Window child;
8138 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8139 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8140
8141 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8142 is already for the top-left corner. */
8143 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8144 return;
8145
8146 /* Find the offsets of the outside upper-left corner of
8147 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
8148 But do this only if we will need the results. */
8149 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8150 /* This is to get *_pixels_outer_diff. */
8151 x_real_positions (f, &win_x, &win_y);
8152
8153 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8154 position that fits on the screen. */
8155 if (flags & XNegative)
8156 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8157 - 2 * FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8158 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8159 + f->left_pos);
8160
8161 {
8162 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8163
8164 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8165 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8166 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8167
8168 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8169 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8170 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8171 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8172 is right, though.
8173
8174 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8175 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8176
8177 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8178 #endif
8179
8180 if (flags & YNegative)
8181 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
8182 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->y_pixels_outer_diff
8183
8184 /* Assume the window manager decorations are the same size on
8185 three sides, i.e. left, right and bottom. This is to
8186 compensate for the bottom part. */
8187 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8188 - height
8189 + f->top_pos);
8190 }
8191
8192 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8193 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8194 so the flags should correspond. */
8195 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8196 }
8197
8198 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8199 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8200 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8201 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8202 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8203
8204 void
8205 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8206 struct frame *f;
8207 register int xoff, yoff;
8208 int change_gravity;
8209 {
8210 int modified_top, modified_left;
8211
8212 if (change_gravity > 0)
8213 {
8214 f->top_pos = yoff;
8215 f->left_pos = xoff;
8216 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8217 if (xoff < 0)
8218 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8219 if (yoff < 0)
8220 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8221 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8222 }
8223 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8224
8225 BLOCK_INPUT;
8226 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8227
8228 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8229 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8230
8231 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8232 {
8233 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8234 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8235 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8236 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8237 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8238 }
8239
8240 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8241 modified_left, modified_top);
8242
8243 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8244 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8245 {
8246 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8247 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8248 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8249 }
8250
8251 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8252 }
8253
8254 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8255 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8256 static void
8257 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8258 struct frame *f;
8259 {
8260 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8261 {
8262 int width, height, ign;
8263
8264 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8265
8266 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8267
8268 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8269 when setting WM manager hints.
8270 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8271 x_check_expected_move. */
8272 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8273 {
8274 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8275 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8276 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8277
8278 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8279 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8280 }
8281 }
8282 }
8283
8284 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8285 the window.
8286 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8287 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8288 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8289 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8290 static void
8291 x_check_expected_move (f)
8292 struct frame *f;
8293 {
8294 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8295 {
8296 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8297 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8298
8299 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8300 {
8301 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8302 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8303 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8304
8305 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
8306 }
8307 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8308 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8309
8310 /* Just do this once */
8311 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8312 }
8313 }
8314
8315
8316 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8317 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8318 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8319 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8320
8321 static void
8322 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8323 struct frame *f;
8324 int change_gravity;
8325 int cols, rows;
8326 {
8327 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8328
8329 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8330 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8331 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8332 ? 0
8333 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8334 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8335 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8336
8337 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8338
8339 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8340 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8341
8342 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8343 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8344
8345 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8346 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8347 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8348
8349 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8350 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8351 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8352 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8353
8354 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8355 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8356 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8357 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8358 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8359
8360 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8361 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8362 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8363 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8364 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8365
8366 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8367 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8368 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8369 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8370 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8371
8372 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8373 }
8374
8375
8376 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8377 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8378 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8379 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8380
8381 void
8382 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8383 struct frame *f;
8384 int change_gravity;
8385 int cols, rows;
8386 {
8387 BLOCK_INPUT;
8388
8389 #ifdef USE_GTK
8390 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8391 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8392 else
8393 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8394 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8395
8396 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8397 {
8398 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8399 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8400 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8401 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8402 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8403 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8404 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8405 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8406 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8407 }
8408 else
8409 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8410
8411 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8412
8413 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8414
8415 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8416
8417 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8418 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8419
8420 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8421 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8422 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8423 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8424 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8425
8426 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8427 }
8428 \f
8429 /* Mouse warping. */
8430
8431 void
8432 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8433 struct frame *f;
8434 int x, y;
8435 {
8436 int pix_x, pix_y;
8437
8438 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8439 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8440
8441 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8442 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8443
8444 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8445 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8446
8447 BLOCK_INPUT;
8448
8449 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8450 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8451 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8452 }
8453
8454 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8455
8456 void
8457 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8458 struct frame *f;
8459 int pix_x, pix_y;
8460 {
8461 BLOCK_INPUT;
8462
8463 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8464 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8465 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8466 }
8467 \f
8468 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8469
8470 void
8471 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8472 struct frame *f;
8473 {
8474 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8475 x_raise_frame (f);
8476 #endif
8477 #if 0
8478 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8479 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8480 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8481 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8482 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8483 #endif /* ! 0 */
8484 }
8485
8486 void
8487 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8488 struct frame *f;
8489 {
8490 #if 0
8491 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8492 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8493 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8494 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8495 #endif /* ! 0 */
8496 }
8497
8498 /* Raise frame F. */
8499
8500 void
8501 x_raise_frame (f)
8502 struct frame *f;
8503 {
8504 if (f->async_visible)
8505 {
8506 BLOCK_INPUT;
8507 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8508 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8509 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8510 }
8511 }
8512
8513 /* Lower frame F. */
8514
8515 void
8516 x_lower_frame (f)
8517 struct frame *f;
8518 {
8519 if (f->async_visible)
8520 {
8521 BLOCK_INPUT;
8522 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8523 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8524 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8525 }
8526 }
8527
8528 static void
8529 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8530 FRAME_PTR f;
8531 int raise_flag;
8532 {
8533 if (raise_flag)
8534 x_raise_frame (f);
8535 else
8536 x_lower_frame (f);
8537 }
8538 \f
8539 /* Change of visibility. */
8540
8541 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8542 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8543 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8544 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8545 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8546 finishes with it. */
8547
8548 void
8549 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8550 struct frame *f;
8551 {
8552 Lisp_Object type;
8553 int original_top, original_left;
8554 int retry_count = 2;
8555
8556 retry:
8557
8558 BLOCK_INPUT;
8559
8560 type = x_icon_type (f);
8561 if (!NILP (type))
8562 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8563
8564 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8565 {
8566 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8567 call x_set_offset a second time
8568 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8569 before the window gets really visible. */
8570 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8571 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8572 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8573
8574 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8575
8576 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8577 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8578 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8579 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8580 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8581 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8582 #ifdef USE_GTK
8583 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8584 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8585 #else
8586 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8587 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8588 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8589 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8590 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8591 to come back ok without this. */
8592 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8593 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8594 #endif
8595 }
8596
8597 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8598
8599 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8600 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8601 so that incoming events are handled. */
8602 {
8603 Lisp_Object frame;
8604 int count;
8605 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8606 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8607 will set it when they are handled. */
8608 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8609
8610 original_left = f->left_pos;
8611 original_top = f->top_pos;
8612
8613 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8614 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8615
8616 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8617
8618 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8619 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8620 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8621 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8622
8623 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8624 because the window manager may choose the position
8625 and we don't want to override it. */
8626
8627 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8628 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8629 && previously_visible)
8630 {
8631 Drawable rootw;
8632 int x, y;
8633 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8634
8635 BLOCK_INPUT;
8636
8637 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8638 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8639 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8640 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8641 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8642 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8643 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8644 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8645 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8646
8647 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8648 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8649 original_left, original_top);
8650
8651 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8652 }
8653
8654 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8655
8656 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8657 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8658 MapNotify at all.. */
8659 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8660 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8661 {
8662 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8663 x_sync (f);
8664
8665 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8666 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8667 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8668 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8669 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8670 probably a bug. */
8671 if (input_polling_used ())
8672 {
8673 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8674 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8675 handler reset it. */
8676 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8677 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8678 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8679 poll_for_input_1 ();
8680 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8681 }
8682
8683 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8684 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8685 }
8686
8687 /* 2000-09-28: In
8688
8689 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8690 (iconify-frame f)
8691 (raise-frame f))
8692
8693 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8694 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8695 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8696 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8697
8698 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8699 goto retry;
8700 }
8701 }
8702
8703 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8704
8705 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8706
8707 void
8708 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8709 struct frame *f;
8710 {
8711 Window window;
8712
8713 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8714 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8715
8716 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8717 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8718 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8719
8720 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8721 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8722 return;
8723 #endif
8724
8725 BLOCK_INPUT;
8726
8727 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8728 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8729 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8730 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8731 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8732 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8733
8734 #ifdef USE_GTK
8735 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8736 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8737 else
8738 #endif
8739 {
8740 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8741
8742 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8743 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8744 {
8745 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8746 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8747 }
8748 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8749
8750 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8751 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8752 {
8753 XEvent unmap;
8754
8755 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8756 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8757 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8758 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8759 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8760 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8761 False,
8762 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8763 &unmap))
8764 {
8765 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8766 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8767 }
8768 }
8769
8770 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8771 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8772 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8773 }
8774
8775 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8776 just by the event that we get from the server.
8777 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8778 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8779 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8780 f->visible = 0;
8781 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8782 f->async_visible = 0;
8783 f->async_iconified = 0;
8784
8785 x_sync (f);
8786
8787 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8788 }
8789
8790 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8791
8792 void
8793 x_iconify_frame (f)
8794 struct frame *f;
8795 {
8796 int result;
8797 Lisp_Object type;
8798
8799 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8800 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8801 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8802
8803 if (f->async_iconified)
8804 return;
8805
8806 BLOCK_INPUT;
8807
8808 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8809
8810 type = x_icon_type (f);
8811 if (!NILP (type))
8812 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8813
8814 #ifdef USE_GTK
8815 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8816 {
8817 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8818 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8819
8820 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8821 f->iconified = 1;
8822 f->visible = 1;
8823 f->async_iconified = 1;
8824 f->async_visible = 0;
8825 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8826 return;
8827 }
8828 #endif
8829
8830 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8831
8832 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8833 {
8834 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8835 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8836 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8837 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8838 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8839 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8840 so we have to record it here. */
8841 f->iconified = 1;
8842 f->visible = 1;
8843 f->async_iconified = 1;
8844 f->async_visible = 0;
8845 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8846 return;
8847 }
8848
8849 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8850 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8851 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8852 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8853
8854 if (!result)
8855 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8856
8857 f->async_iconified = 1;
8858 f->async_visible = 0;
8859
8860
8861 BLOCK_INPUT;
8862 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8863 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8864 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8865
8866 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8867 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8868 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8869 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8870
8871 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8872 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8873
8874 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8875 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8876 {
8877 XEvent message;
8878
8879 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8880 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8881 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8882 message.xclient.format = 32;
8883 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8884
8885 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8886 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8887 False,
8888 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8889 &message))
8890 {
8891 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8892 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8893 }
8894 }
8895
8896 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8897 IconicState. */
8898 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8899
8900 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8901 {
8902 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8903 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8904 }
8905
8906 f->async_iconified = 1;
8907 f->async_visible = 0;
8908
8909 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8910 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8911 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8912 }
8913
8914 \f
8915 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8916
8917 void
8918 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8919 struct frame *f;
8920 {
8921 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8922 Lisp_Object bar;
8923 struct scroll_bar *b;
8924
8925 BLOCK_INPUT;
8926
8927 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8928 commands to the X server. */
8929 if (dpyinfo->display)
8930 {
8931 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8932 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8933
8934 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8935 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8936 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8937 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8938 toolkit scroll bars. */
8939 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8940 {
8941 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8942 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8943 }
8944 #endif
8945
8946 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8947 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8948 free_frame_xic (f);
8949 #endif
8950
8951 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8952 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8953 {
8954 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8955 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8956 }
8957 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8958 we are using a toolkit. */
8959 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8960 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8961
8962 free_frame_menubar (f);
8963 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8964
8965 #ifdef USE_GTK
8966 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8967 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8968 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8969 {
8970 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8971 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8972 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8973 }
8974 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8975
8976 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8977 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8978 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8979
8980 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8981 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8982 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8983 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8984 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8985 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8986
8987 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8988 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8989 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8990 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8991 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8992 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8993 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8994 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8995 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8996 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
8997 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8998 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
8999 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9000 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9001 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9002
9003 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9004 free_frame_faces (f);
9005
9006 x_free_gcs (f);
9007 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9008 }
9009
9010 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9011 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9012
9013 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9014 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9015
9016 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9017 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9018 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9019 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9020 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9021 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9022
9023 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9024 {
9025 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9026 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9027 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9028 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9029 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9030 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9031 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9032 }
9033
9034 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9035 }
9036
9037
9038 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9039
9040 void
9041 x_destroy_window (f)
9042 struct frame *f;
9043 {
9044 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9045
9046 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9047 commands to the X server. */
9048 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9049 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9050
9051 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9052 }
9053
9054 \f
9055 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9056
9057 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9058 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9059 that the window now has.
9060 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9061 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9062 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9063
9064 #ifndef USE_GTK
9065 void
9066 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9067 struct frame *f;
9068 long flags;
9069 int user_position;
9070 {
9071 XSizeHints size_hints;
9072
9073 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9074 Arg al[2];
9075 int ac = 0;
9076 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9077 #endif
9078
9079 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9080
9081 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9082 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9083
9084 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9085 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9086
9087 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9088 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9089 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9090 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9091 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9092 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9093 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9094 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9095 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9096 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9097
9098 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9099 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9100 size_hints.max_width
9101 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9102 size_hints.max_height
9103 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9104
9105 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9106
9107 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9108 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9109 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9110 {
9111 int base_width, base_height;
9112 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9113
9114 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9115 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9116
9117 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9118
9119 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9120 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9121 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9122 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9123 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9124
9125 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9126 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9127 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9128
9129 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9130 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9131 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9132 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9133 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9134 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9135 #else
9136 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9137 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9138 #endif
9139 }
9140
9141 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9142 if (flags)
9143 {
9144 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9145 goto no_read;
9146 }
9147 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9148
9149 {
9150 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9151 long supplied_return;
9152 int value;
9153
9154 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9155 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9156 &supplied_return);
9157 #else
9158 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9159 #endif
9160
9161 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9162 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9163 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9164 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9165 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9166 #endif
9167
9168 if (flags)
9169 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9170 else
9171 {
9172 if (value == 0)
9173 hints.flags = 0;
9174 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9175 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9176 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9177 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9178 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9179 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9180 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9181 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9182 }
9183 }
9184
9185 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9186 no_read:
9187 #endif
9188
9189 #ifdef PWinGravity
9190 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9191 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9192
9193 if (user_position)
9194 {
9195 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9196 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9197 }
9198 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9199
9200 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9201 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9202 #else
9203 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9204 #endif
9205 }
9206 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9207
9208 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9209
9210 void
9211 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9212 struct frame *f;
9213 int state;
9214 {
9215 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9216 Arg al[1];
9217
9218 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9219 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9220 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9221 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9222
9223 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9224 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9225
9226 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9227 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9228 }
9229
9230 void
9231 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9232 struct frame *f;
9233 int pixmap_id;
9234 {
9235 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9236
9237 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9238 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9239 #endif
9240
9241 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9242 {
9243 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9244 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9245 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9246 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9247 }
9248 else
9249 {
9250 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9251 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9252 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9253 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9254 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9255 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9256 best to explicitly give up. */
9257 #if 0
9258 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9259 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9260 #else
9261 return;
9262 #endif
9263 }
9264
9265 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9266
9267 {
9268 Arg al[1];
9269 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9270 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9271 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9272 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9273 }
9274
9275 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9276
9277 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9278 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9279
9280 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9281 }
9282
9283 void
9284 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9285 struct frame *f;
9286 int icon_x, icon_y;
9287 {
9288 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9289
9290 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9291 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9292 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9293
9294 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9295 }
9296
9297 \f
9298 /***********************************************************************
9299 Fonts
9300 ***********************************************************************/
9301
9302 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9303
9304 struct font_info *
9305 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9306 FRAME_PTR f;
9307 int font_idx;
9308 {
9309 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9310 }
9311
9312
9313 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9314
9315 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9316 to be listed.
9317
9318 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9319
9320 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9321 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9322 on how many fonts to match. */
9323
9324 Lisp_Object
9325 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9326 struct frame *f;
9327 Lisp_Object pattern;
9328 int size;
9329 int maxnames;
9330 {
9331 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9332 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9333 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9334 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9335 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9336 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9337 int count;
9338 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9339
9340 if (size < 0)
9341 {
9342 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9343 size = 0;
9344 }
9345
9346 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9347 if (NILP (patterns))
9348 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9349
9350 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9351 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9352 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9353
9354 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9355 {
9356 int num_fonts;
9357 char **names = NULL;
9358
9359 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9360 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9361 The cache is an alist of the form:
9362 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9363 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9364 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9365 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9366 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9367 if (!NILP (list))
9368 {
9369 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9370 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9371 goto label_cached;
9372 }
9373
9374 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9375
9376 BLOCK_INPUT;
9377 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9378
9379 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9380 {
9381 XFontStruct *font;
9382 unsigned long value;
9383
9384 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9385 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9386 {
9387 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9388 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9389 font = NULL;
9390 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9391 }
9392
9393 if (font
9394 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9395 {
9396 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9397 int len = strlen (name);
9398 char *tmp;
9399
9400 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9401 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9402 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9403 if (len == 0)
9404 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9405 else
9406 {
9407 num_fonts = 1;
9408 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9409 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9410 simple var. */
9411 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9412 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9413 XFree (name);
9414 }
9415 }
9416 else
9417 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9418
9419 if (font)
9420 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9421 }
9422
9423 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9424 {
9425 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9426 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9427 if (maxnames < 0)
9428 {
9429 int limit;
9430
9431 for (limit = 500;;)
9432 {
9433 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9434 if (num_fonts == limit)
9435 {
9436 BLOCK_INPUT;
9437 XFreeFontNames (names);
9438 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9439 limit *= 2;
9440 }
9441 else
9442 break;
9443 }
9444 }
9445 else
9446 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9447 &num_fonts);
9448
9449 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9450 {
9451 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9452 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9453 names = NULL;
9454 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9455 }
9456 }
9457
9458 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9459 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9460
9461 if (names)
9462 {
9463 int i;
9464
9465 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9466 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9467 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9468 {
9469 int width = 0;
9470 char *p = names[i];
9471 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9472
9473 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9474 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9475 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9476 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9477 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9478 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9479 while (*p)
9480 if (*p++ == '-')
9481 {
9482 dashes++;
9483 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9484 width = atoi (p);
9485 else if (dashes == 9)
9486 resx = atoi (p);
9487 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9488 average_width = atoi (p);
9489 }
9490
9491 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9492 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9493 {
9494 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9495 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9496 {
9497 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9498 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9499 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9500 >= 0))
9501 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9502 width of this font. */
9503 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9504 else
9505 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9506 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9507 }
9508 }
9509 }
9510
9511 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9512 {
9513 BLOCK_INPUT;
9514 XFreeFontNames (names);
9515 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9516 }
9517 }
9518
9519 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9520 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9521 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9522
9523 label_cached:
9524 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9525
9526 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9527 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9528 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9529 {
9530 int found_size;
9531
9532 tem = XCAR (list);
9533
9534 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9535 continue;
9536 if (!size)
9537 {
9538 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9539 continue;
9540 }
9541
9542 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9543 {
9544 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9545 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9546 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9547
9548 BLOCK_INPUT;
9549 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9550 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9551 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9552 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9553 {
9554 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9555 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9556 thisinfo = NULL;
9557 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9558 }
9559 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9561
9562 if (thisinfo)
9563 {
9564 XSETCDR (tem,
9565 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9566 ? make_number (0)
9567 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9568 BLOCK_INPUT;
9569 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9570 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9571 }
9572 else
9573 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9574 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9575 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9576 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9577 }
9578
9579 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9580 if (found_size == size)
9581 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9582 else if (found_size > 0)
9583 {
9584 if (NILP (second_best))
9585 second_best = tem;
9586 else if (found_size < size)
9587 {
9588 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9589 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9590 second_best = tem;
9591 }
9592 else
9593 {
9594 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9595 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9596 second_best = tem;
9597 }
9598 }
9599 }
9600 if (!NILP (newlist))
9601 break;
9602 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9603 {
9604 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9605 break;
9606 }
9607 }
9608
9609 return newlist;
9610 }
9611
9612
9613 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9614
9615 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9616 font table. */
9617
9618 static void
9619 x_check_font (f, font)
9620 struct frame *f;
9621 XFontStruct *font;
9622 {
9623 int i;
9624 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9625
9626 xassert (font != NULL);
9627
9628 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9629 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9630 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9631 break;
9632
9633 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9634 }
9635
9636 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9637
9638 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9639 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9640 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9641 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9642 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9643
9644 static INLINE void
9645 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9646 XFontStruct *font;
9647 int *w, *h;
9648 {
9649 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9650 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9651
9652 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9653 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9654 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9655 if (*w <= 0)
9656 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9657 }
9658
9659
9660 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9661 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9662 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9663 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9664 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9665
9666 static int
9667 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9668 struct frame *f;
9669 {
9670 int i;
9671 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9672 XFontStruct *font;
9673 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9674 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9675
9676 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9677 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9678
9679 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9680 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9681 {
9682 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9683 int w, h;
9684
9685 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9686 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9687 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9688
9689 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9690 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9691 }
9692
9693 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9694 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9695
9696 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9697 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9698 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9699 }
9700
9701
9702 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9703 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9704 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9705 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9706
9707 struct font_info *
9708 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9709 struct frame *f;
9710 register char *fontname;
9711 int size;
9712 {
9713 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9714 Lisp_Object font_names;
9715 int count;
9716
9717 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9718 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9719 we already have by comparing names. */
9720 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9721
9722 if (!NILP (font_names))
9723 {
9724 Lisp_Object tail;
9725 int i;
9726
9727 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9728 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9729 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9730 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9731 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9732 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9733 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9734 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9735 }
9736
9737 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9738 {
9739 char *full_name;
9740 XFontStruct *font;
9741 struct font_info *fontp;
9742 unsigned long value;
9743 int i;
9744
9745 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9746 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9747 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9748 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9749 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9750 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9751 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9752
9753 BLOCK_INPUT;
9754 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9755 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9756 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9757 {
9758 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9759 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9760 font = NULL;
9761 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9762 }
9763 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9764 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9765 if (!font)
9766 return NULL;
9767
9768 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9769 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9770 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9771 break;
9772
9773 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9774 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9775 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9776 {
9777 int sz;
9778 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9779 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9780 dpyinfo->font_table
9781 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9782 }
9783
9784 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9785 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9786 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9787
9788 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9789 BLOCK_INPUT;
9790 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9791 fontp->font = font;
9792 fontp->font_idx = i;
9793 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9794 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9795
9796 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9797 full_name = 0;
9798 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9799 {
9800 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9801 char *p = name;
9802 int dashes = 0;
9803
9804 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9805 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9806 so don't use it.
9807 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9808 stored in them. */
9809 while (*p)
9810 {
9811 if (*p == '-')
9812 dashes++;
9813 p++;
9814 }
9815
9816 if (dashes >= 13)
9817 {
9818 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9819 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9820 }
9821
9822 XFree (name);
9823 }
9824
9825 if (full_name != 0)
9826 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9827 else
9828 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9829
9830 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9831 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9832
9833 if (NILP (font_names))
9834 {
9835 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9836 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9837 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9838 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9839 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9840 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9841 Qnil);
9842
9843 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9844 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9845 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9846 make_number (fontp->size)),
9847 Qnil)),
9848 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9849 if (full_name)
9850 {
9851 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9852 Qnil);
9853 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9854 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9855 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9856 make_number (fontp->size)),
9857 Qnil)),
9858 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9859 }
9860 }
9861
9862 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9863 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9864 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9865 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9866 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9867 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9868 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9869 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9870 fontp->encoding[1]
9871 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9872 /* 1-byte font */
9873 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9874 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9875 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9876 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9877 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9878 /* 2-byte font */
9879 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9880 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9881 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9882 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9883 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9884 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9885 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9886 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9887 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9888 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9889 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9890 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9891 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9892
9893 fontp->baseline_offset
9894 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9895 ? (long) value : 0);
9896 fontp->relative_compose
9897 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9898 ? (long) value : 0);
9899 fontp->default_ascent
9900 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9901 ? (long) value : 0);
9902
9903 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9904 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9905 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9906 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9907 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9908 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9909 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9910 return fontp;
9911 }
9912 }
9913
9914
9915 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9916 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9917
9918 struct font_info *
9919 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9920 struct frame *f;
9921 register char *fontname;
9922 {
9923 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9924 int i;
9925
9926 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9927 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9928 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9929 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9930 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9931 return NULL;
9932 }
9933
9934
9935 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9936 `encoder' of the structure. */
9937
9938 void
9939 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9940 struct font_info *fontp;
9941 {
9942 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9943
9944 elt = Qnil;
9945 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9946 {
9947 elt = XCAR (list);
9948 if (CONSP (elt)
9949 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9950 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9951 >= 0)
9952 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9953 >= 0)))
9954 break;
9955 }
9956
9957 if (! NILP (list))
9958 {
9959 struct ccl_program *ccl
9960 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9961
9962 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9963 xfree (ccl);
9964 else
9965 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9966 }
9967 }
9968
9969
9970 \f
9971 /***********************************************************************
9972 Initialization
9973 ***********************************************************************/
9974
9975 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9976 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9977 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9978 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9979
9980 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9981 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9982 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9983
9984 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9985 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9986 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9987 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9988 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9989 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9990 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9991 };
9992 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9993
9994 static int x_initialized;
9995
9996 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
9997 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9998 the screen number from the server number. */
9999 static int
10000 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10001 const char *name1, *name2;
10002 {
10003 int seen_colon = 0;
10004 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10005 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10006 int length_until_period = 0;
10007
10008 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10009 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10010 length_until_period++;
10011
10012 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10013 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10014 name1 += 4;
10015 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10016 name2 += 4;
10017 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10018 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10019 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10020 name1 += system_name_length;
10021 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10022 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10023 name2 += system_name_length;
10024 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10025 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10026 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10027 name1 += length_until_period;
10028 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10029 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10030 name2 += length_until_period;
10031
10032 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10033 {
10034 if (*name1 == ':')
10035 seen_colon++;
10036 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10037 return 1;
10038 }
10039 return (seen_colon
10040 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10041 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10042 }
10043 #endif
10044
10045 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10046 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10047 to 5. */
10048 static void
10049 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10050 unsigned long mask;
10051 int *bits;
10052 int *offset;
10053 {
10054 int nr = 0;
10055 int off = 0;
10056
10057 while (!(mask & 1))
10058 {
10059 off++;
10060 mask >>= 1;
10061 }
10062
10063 while (mask & 1)
10064 {
10065 nr++;
10066 mask >>= 1;
10067 }
10068
10069 *offset = off;
10070 *bits = nr;
10071 }
10072
10073 struct x_display_info *
10074 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10075 Lisp_Object display_name;
10076 char *xrm_option;
10077 char *resource_name;
10078 {
10079 int connection;
10080 Display *dpy;
10081 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10082 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10083
10084 BLOCK_INPUT;
10085
10086 if (!x_initialized)
10087 {
10088 x_initialize ();
10089 ++x_initialized;
10090 }
10091
10092 #ifdef USE_GTK
10093 {
10094 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10095 int argc;
10096 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10097 char **argv2 = argv;
10098 GdkAtom atom;
10099
10100 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10101 {
10102 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10103 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10104 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10105 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10106 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10107 }
10108 else
10109 {
10110 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10111 argv[argc] = 0;
10112
10113 argc = 0;
10114 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10115
10116 if (! NILP (display_name))
10117 {
10118 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10119 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10120 }
10121
10122 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10123 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10124
10125 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10126 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10127 #endif
10128
10129 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10130
10131 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10132 fixup_locale ();
10133 xg_initialize ();
10134
10135 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10136
10137 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10138 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10139
10140 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10141 {
10142 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10143 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10144 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10145
10146 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10147 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10148 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10149
10150 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10151 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10152
10153 UNGCPRO;
10154 }
10155
10156 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10157 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10158 }
10159 }
10160 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10161 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10162 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10163 errors with X11R5:
10164 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10165 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10166 So let's not use it until R6. */
10167 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10168 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10169 #endif
10170
10171 {
10172 int argc = 0;
10173 char *argv[3];
10174
10175 argv[0] = "";
10176 argc = 1;
10177 if (xrm_option)
10178 {
10179 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10180 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10181 }
10182 turn_on_atimers (0);
10183 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10184 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10185 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10186 &argc, argv);
10187 turn_on_atimers (1);
10188
10189 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10190 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10191 fixup_locale ();
10192 #endif
10193 }
10194
10195 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10196 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10197 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10198 #endif
10199 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10200 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10201 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10202
10203 /* Detect failure. */
10204 if (dpy == 0)
10205 {
10206 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10207 return 0;
10208 }
10209
10210 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10211
10212 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10213 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10214
10215 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10216 {
10217 struct x_display_info *share;
10218 Lisp_Object tail;
10219
10220 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10221 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10222 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10223 SDATA (display_name)))
10224 break;
10225 if (share)
10226 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10227 else
10228 {
10229 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10230 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10231 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10232 {
10233 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10234 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10235 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10236 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10237 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10238 BLOCK_INPUT;
10239 }
10240
10241 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10242 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10243 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10244 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10245 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10246 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10247 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10248 }
10249 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10250 }
10251 #endif
10252
10253 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10254 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10255 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10256
10257 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10258 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10259 x_display_name_list);
10260 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10261
10262 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10263
10264 #if 0
10265 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10266 #endif /* ! 0 */
10267
10268 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10269 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10270 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10271 + 2);
10272 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10273 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10274
10275 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10276 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10277
10278 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10279 #ifdef USE_GTK
10280 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10281 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10282 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10283
10284 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10285 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10286
10287 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10288 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10289 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10290 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10291 #else
10292 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10293 #endif
10294 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10295 all versions. */
10296 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10297
10298 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10299 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10300 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10301 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10302 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10303 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10304 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10305 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10306 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10307 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10308 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10309 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10310 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10311 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10312 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10313 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10314 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10315 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10317 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10318 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10319 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10320 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10321 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10322 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10323 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10324 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10325 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10326 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10327 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10328 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10329 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10330 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10331
10332 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10333 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10334 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10335
10336 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10337 {
10338 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10339 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10340 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10341 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10342 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10343 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10344 }
10345
10346 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10347 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10348 {
10349 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10350 {
10351 Lisp_Object value;
10352 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10353 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10354 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10355 Qnil, Qnil);
10356 if (STRINGP (value)
10357 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10358 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10359 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10360 }
10361 }
10362 else
10363 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10364 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10365
10366 {
10367 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10368 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10369 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10370 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10371 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10372 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10373 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10374 }
10375
10376 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10377 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10378 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10379 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10380 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10381 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10382 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10383 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10384 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10385 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10386 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10387 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10388 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10389 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10390 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10391 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10392 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10393 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10394 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10395 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10396 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10397 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10398 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10399 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10400 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10401 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10402 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10403 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10404 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10405 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10406 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10407 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10408 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10409 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10410 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10411 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10412 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10413 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10414 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10415 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10416 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10417 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10418 /* For properties of font. */
10419 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10420 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10422 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10423 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10424 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10425 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10426 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10427
10428 /* Ghostscript support. */
10429 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10430 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10431
10432 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10433 False);
10434
10435 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10436
10437 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10438 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10439
10440 {
10441 char null_bits[1];
10442
10443 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10444
10445 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10446 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10447 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10448 1);
10449 }
10450
10451 {
10452 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10453 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10454 dpyinfo->gray
10455 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10456 gray_bitmap_bits,
10457 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10458 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10459 }
10460
10461 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10462 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10463 #endif
10464
10465 #ifdef subprocesses
10466 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10467 if (connection != 0)
10468 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10469 #endif
10470
10471 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10472 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10473 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10474 /* stdin is a socket here */
10475 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10476 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10477 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10478 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10479 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10480 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10481
10482 #ifdef SIGIO
10483 if (interrupt_input)
10484 init_sigio (connection);
10485 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10486
10487 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10488 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10489 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10490 so that Xt does not crash. */
10491 {
10492 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10493 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10494 Font font;
10495 int count;
10496
10497 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10498 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10499 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10500 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10501 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10502 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10503 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10504 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10505 abort ();
10506 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10507 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10508 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10509 }
10510 #endif
10511 #endif
10512
10513 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10514 for debugging X code. */
10515 {
10516 Lisp_Object value;
10517 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10518 build_string ("synchronous"),
10519 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10520 Qnil, Qnil);
10521 if (STRINGP (value)
10522 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10523 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10524 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10525 }
10526
10527 {
10528 Lisp_Object value;
10529 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10530 build_string ("useXIM"),
10531 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10532 Qnil, Qnil);
10533 #ifdef USE_XIM
10534 if (STRINGP (value)
10535 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10536 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10537 use_xim = 0;
10538 #else
10539 if (STRINGP (value)
10540 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10541 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10542 use_xim = 1;
10543 #endif
10544 }
10545
10546 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10547 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10548 if (x_initialized == 1)
10549 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10550 #endif
10551
10552 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10553
10554 return dpyinfo;
10555 }
10556 \f
10557 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10558 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10559
10560 void
10561 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10562 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10563 {
10564 int i;
10565
10566 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10567
10568 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10569 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10570 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10571 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10572 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10573 else
10574 {
10575 Lisp_Object tail;
10576
10577 tail = x_display_name_list;
10578 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10579 {
10580 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10581 {
10582 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10583 break;
10584 }
10585 tail = XCDR (tail);
10586 }
10587 }
10588
10589 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10590 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10591
10592 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10593 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10594 else
10595 {
10596 struct x_display_info *tail;
10597
10598 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10599 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10600 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10601 }
10602
10603 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10604 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10605 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10606 #endif
10607 #endif
10608 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10609 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10610 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10611 #endif
10612 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10613 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10614 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10615 #endif
10616
10617 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10618 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10619 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10620 {
10621 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10622 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10623 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10624 }
10625
10626 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10627 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10628
10629 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10630 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10631 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10632 xfree (dpyinfo);
10633 }
10634
10635 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10636
10637 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10638 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10639 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10640 that slows us down. */
10641
10642 static void
10643 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10644 struct atimer *timer;
10645 {
10646 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10647 {
10648 BLOCK_INPUT;
10649 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10650 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10651 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10652 }
10653 }
10654
10655 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10656
10657 \f
10658 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10659
10660 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10661
10662 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10663 {
10664 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10665 x_produce_glyphs,
10666 x_write_glyphs,
10667 x_insert_glyphs,
10668 x_clear_end_of_line,
10669 x_scroll_run,
10670 x_after_update_window_line,
10671 x_update_window_begin,
10672 x_update_window_end,
10673 x_cursor_to,
10674 x_flush,
10675 #ifndef XFlush
10676 x_flush,
10677 #else
10678 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10679 #endif
10680 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10681 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10682 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10683 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10684 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10685 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10686 x_per_char_metric,
10687 x_encode_char,
10688 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10689 x_draw_glyph_string,
10690 x_define_frame_cursor,
10691 x_clear_frame_area,
10692 x_draw_window_cursor,
10693 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10694 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10695 };
10696
10697 void
10698 x_initialize ()
10699 {
10700 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10701
10702 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10703 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10704 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10705 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10706 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10707 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10708 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10709 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10710 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10711 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10712 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10713 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10714 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10715 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10716 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10717 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10718 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10719 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10720
10721 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10722 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10723 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10724 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10725 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10726 off the bottom */
10727 baud_rate = 19200;
10728
10729 x_noop_count = 0;
10730 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10731 any_help_event_p = 0;
10732
10733 #ifdef USE_GTK
10734 current_count = -1;
10735 #endif
10736
10737 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10738 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10739
10740 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10741 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10742
10743 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10744
10745 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10746 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10747 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10748 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10749 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10750 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10751 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10752
10753 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10754
10755 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10756 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10757 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10758 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10759 widgets don't behave normally. */
10760 {
10761 EMACS_TIME interval;
10762 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10763 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10764 }
10765 #endif
10766
10767 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10768 #ifndef USE_GTK
10769 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10770 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10771 #endif
10772 #endif
10773
10774 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10775 original error handler. */
10776 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10777 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10778
10779 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10780 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10781 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10782 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10783
10784 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10785 }
10786
10787
10788 void
10789 syms_of_xterm ()
10790 {
10791 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10792 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10793
10794 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10795 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10796
10797 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10798 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10799
10800 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10801 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10802
10803 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10804 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10805 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10806 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10807
10808 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10809 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10810
10811 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10812 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10813 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10814 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10815 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10816 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10817 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10818
10819 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10820 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10821 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10822 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10823 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10824 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10825 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10826 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10827 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10828 #elif USE_GTK
10829 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10830 #else
10831 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10832 #endif
10833 #else
10834 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10835 #endif
10836
10837 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10838 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10839
10840 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10841 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10842 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10843 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10844 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10845 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10846 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10847 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10848 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10849
10850 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10851 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10852 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10853 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10854 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10855 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10856
10857 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10858 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10859 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10860 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10861 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10862 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10863
10864 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10865 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10866 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10867 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10868 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10869 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10870
10871 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10872 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10873 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10874 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10875 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10876 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10877
10878 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10879 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10880 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10881 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10882 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10883 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10884 }
10885
10886 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10887
10888 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10889 (do not change this comment) */